七年级英语上册课件
发布时间:2024-08-01 七年级英语上册课件 七年级英语课件七年级英语上册课件八篇。
探究与“七年级英语上册课件”有关的主题是本文的关注点。教案课件是老师上课做的提前准备,因此想要随便写的话老师们就要注意了。教案是教学评价的重要依据。希望这些资料能供你参考和使用欢迎分享给需要的人!
七年级英语上册课件(篇1)
单词水平测试九
班级 ______________ 姓名 ______________ 分数 ______________
1. Beijing is the c _______________ of the P.R.C as well as the centre of China’s political matters and culture.
2. She wore sun-glasses so that I didn’t r _______________ her at the first sight.
3. Smoking is strictly f _______________ in the gas station.
4. The sunlight is a kind of limitless e _______________ for us to use.
5. He was w _______________ so that we couldn’t hear what he was saying.
6. Children are taught to believe in the _______________ (原则) of equal opportunity for everyone.
7. His work this week hasn’t been up to his usual _______________ (水准).
8. I know your back hurts, but you have to wait _______________ (耐心地) until the doctor arrives.
9. In fact, he felt the condition even _______________ (糟糕) than before.
10. The doctor are busy _______________ (做手术) on the wounded soldier now.
11. The a _______________ of air can easily cause a man to die.
12. Cancer is a kind of disease which is almost i _______________.
13. Please follow these sentence p _______________ to make a few sentences.
14. His teacher asked him not to be c _______________ with himself with a little success.
15. She was e _______________ to that man but got married to this man.
16. The girl was so _______________ (着迷) by the mighty river that she would spend hours sitting on its bank and watching the boats going and coming.
17. It being very hot, the boy had to stand in the _______________ (阴凉处).
18. The city of Nanjing _______________ (目暏) the cruelty of the Japanese invaders.
19. Look, our troops are _______________ (接近) the enemy’s position and will soon attack them.
20. It said that that plane _______________ (坠毁) in the valley.
单词水平测试十
班级 ______________ 姓名 ______________ 分数 ______________
1. What he says is not in h _______________ with what he does.
2. Before taking action, be sure to get p _______________ from your parents.
3. In China the a _______________ population takes up a large part of the whole population.
4. A $ 1,000 r _______________ has been offered for the return of the stolen painting.
5. It doesn’t seem ugly to me; on the c _______________, I think it’s rather beautiful.
6. The models are kept in locked cases as they are too valuable and _______________ (易碎的) for classroom use.
7. Although he was _______________ (残疾的) when he was only ten years of age, yet he aimed high, for which his classmates spoke highly of him.
8. Finally, Chairman made a short speech, _______________ (结束时说) that the plan should be carried out soon.
9. In Britain, some abandoned cats and dogs will be _______________ (收养) by kind-hearted people.
10. It rained _______________ (连续的) for seven days, completely ruining our holiday.
11. As far as I know, that country c _______________ of many tiny islands.
12. I can’t s _______________ my dictionary with you. I don’t like someone else to use it.
13. SARS is a kind of disease s _______________ very quickly.
14. There are seven c _______________ and four oceans in the earth.
15. Volleyball is played t _______________ the world.
16. Smoking _______________ (香烟) is harmful to our health.
17. I’ll _______________ (推荐) you a good book which will give you a lot of knowledge.
18. You’d better have all the programmes _______________ (简化) .
19. We gave our classroom a _______________ (彻底) cleaning before the National Day.
20. There will be a large apple _______________ (收成) in my hometown this year.
单词水平测试九
1. capital 2. recognize 3. forbidden 4. energy 5. whispering 6. principle 7. standard 8. patiently 9. worse 10. operating 11. absence 12. incurable 13. patterns 14. content 15. engaged 16. fasinated 17. shade 18. witnessed 19. approaching 20. crashed
单词水平测试十
1. harmony 2. permission 3. agricultural 4. reward 5. contrary 6. fragile 7. disabled 8. concluding 9. adopted 10. continuously 11. consist of 12. share 13. spreading 14. continents 15. throughout 16. cigrettes 17. recommend 18. simplified 19. thorough 20. harvest
七年级英语上册课件(篇2)
电子课件就是全部输入在电脑中的,通常也都是教师自己上课所背的内容。这里讲的教案与传统上的有很大的不同,下面为大家分享了七年级上册英语的电子课件,欢迎借鉴!
1.学习本课的知识点:
(2)单词:blue,green,red,yellow,black,white,brown,purple,co lor,UFO,CCTV
(3)句型:
—What's this/that?
—It's ...
—What color is it?
—It's ...
2.使学生能运用所学英语,正确地描述物体的颜色。
3.对学生进行美育教育,从小培养他们对美的正确认识。
熟练掌握Ss—Zz八个字母的大小写形式和颜色的表达方法。
这一部分的Guessing game主要是为了让学生从不完整的画面中通过想象,猜出其是什么字母,既复习学过的字母,又丰富学生的想象力。而“What's this?It's ...”既是前一单元的重点句型,也是下一课时使用频率较高的一个句型。我们在游戏的最后用同样的方式引出本堂课所要教授的新字母的小写形式。
For example:
The teacher shows a part of a letter and asks:
Get the students to answer the question like this:
Then show the whole of the letter to let the students check whether they're right or wrong.
导入新课What color is it?
通过字母卡片,复习前面学到的字母及交际用语。
让同学们拿着卡片互相问答。
教师用红色粉笔在黑板上写“A”,询问学生:
The teacher answers himself/herself: It's red.
教师使用不同颜色的粉笔在黑板上写下字母Aa—Rr,让同学们一个接一个地读出来,教师问:
Ss:It's red.(Help the students to answer.)
导入新课 What color is it?
建议3:
T:Good morning,boys and girls.
Good morning,A.
Good morning,B.
(Greet as many students as possible individually.)
T:What color are your clothes?
T:Good.Now please ask and answer questions with your partner about the color of your clothes.
导入新课 What color is it?
Step 2:Present the new letters and words
1.教师通过多媒体呈现一组本课要学习的字母图片,并且每张字母图片颜色不一样,让学生以小组为单位进行辨认。教师可采取竞赛的方式来调动学生的学习积极性。
For example:
T:Look at these pictures.Let's play a game.Who can say these letters and the colors as quickly as possible?If you can,you will be the winner.Now let's begin.
Get some students to ask each other about letters and colors in English,and then do 1a:let the students write the letters for each color.The teacher can offer some help.
2.读一读表示颜色的单词,然后把颜色与对应的单词连起来。
T:They are the names of colors.Draw them on the blackboard or show them on the screen.Now please read after me.You should pay attention to your pronunciation.
Let's match the words with the colors.
建议:
教学过程中我们可以设计一个任务型活动为顺藤摸瓜。在学生学习了有关颜色的词汇后,作为拓展,向学生介绍几个新的表示颜色的词汇,如:dark/light green,orange,pink。这几个词较常见,也很实用。然后通过顺藤摸瓜的游戏加以巩固。具体操作为:
准备10个乒乓球,乒乓球染成10种不同的颜色,然后将10个乒乓球放在一个开口的纸盒子里。上课时,教师找一个学生背对着大家,放音乐,音乐一开始,大家就开始传盒子,音乐一停,手拿盒子的同学马上拿出一个球举起。问控制音乐的同学 “What color is it?” 他猜:“It's red.”。若猜对了,大家说yes,控制音乐的学生继续放音乐;如果大家说“No,it's blue.”,控制音乐的学生下台,由刚才拿球的学生来控制音乐。游戏继续,直到乒乓球在不同学生手里。可以多练几次,让学生充分掌握表示颜色的单词。
该活动参照击鼓传花的游戏而创造。可操作性强,学生积极性也高。能让学生在不知不觉中掌握表示颜色的单词。
1.教师让学生听1b部分的录音,通过听力训练操练所学的新句型。
具体操作建议是:第一遍 让学生只是听,第二遍让学生听并跟读,然后教师让学生进行操练,先学生齐读,然后把学生分成组齐读,最后让个别学生读。通过这种从整体到部分再到个体的机械操练,让学生掌握本课所学的新句型。
2.教师板书并强调What question 句型。
A:What color is it? B:It's red.
A:What color is it? B:It's black.
1.让学生先按照课本的内容练习,建议前后位互问,同位互问,一生随意选择另一学生互问,尽量采取多形式从多角度练习,让更多 的人参与进来。
2.Pa ir work:Let's look at the pictures below.Can you ask and answer questions about the colors?Now work in pairs.Ask your partner about the letters in the pictures.
3.脱离课本,让学生根据身边的事物进行问答,或者用彩笔在白纸上随意写出学过的字母进行问答。
建议1:先复习前面两个单元学过的字母,再过渡到本节课要学习的新字母。
For example:
Please look at the letters.Let's practice saying the letters Aa—Rr in order.
Aa,Bb,Cc,Dd,Ee,Ff,Gg,Hh,Ii,Jj,Kk,Ll,Mm,Nn,Oo,Pp,Qq,Rr
Good.Look at the letters in 2a.They are letters Ss—Zz.Let's listen and repeat them.Pay attention to the pronunciation of the long /i?/sound in T and V and the short /e/ sound in S and Z.The /v/ sounds in V doesn't exist in most Chinese dialects.You should pay special attention.You can't say that like /veI/ or /weI/./zi?/is American English and is also acceptable.
OK.Let's listen and repeat them.
建议2:
1.第一遍让学生只是听,第二遍让学生听并跟读,然后教师让学生进行操练,先学生齐读,然后把学生分成组齐读,最后让个别学生读。通过这种从整 体到部分再到个体的机械操练,让学生掌握本课所学的新字母。
2.教师出示一些带有字母的卡片,并涂上颜色,让学生任意抽取一张,读出字母和表示卡片颜色的单词。为了培养学生的竞争意识,也可以让学生以组为单位进行比赛,每个组选一名代表,看哪个组读得准,读得响亮。
Look at the letters in 2b.They are not arranged alphabetically.Now listen to the tape and number the letters in order,and then read them aloud.
仔细观察2c中字母大小写书写格式,并抄写。教师仔细观察同学们的书写情况,针对存在的`问题及时在黑板上反馈。
建议1:教师在黑板上画出四线格,先演示给同学们看。
建议2:利用投 影仪,以动态的形式展示给同学们看。
根据大写字母写出小写字母,根据小写字母写出大写字母,必须使用四线格。
写完之后找同学读一读,再次巩固字母的读音。对于书写比较漂亮的同学,教师将其书写投影,供大家学习,同时也能激励大家认真书写。
建议:这个游戏叫“非常接触”。在活动前先向学生介绍字母大小写的规则。通过活动——非常接触加以巩固。以每一排为一组,将全班分成若干组,教师分别发给每组最后一排的学生一张纸片,上面写有一个字母,只允许这个学生看这个字母,在教师说“开始”后,最后一排的学生即用手指把纸片上的字母写在前面学生的背上……这样依次进行下去,最后第一排的学生把所传的字母写到黑板的四线格上,传得最快最准确的组获胜。
这一部分并不一定要学生掌握这些缩略词的完整的拼法,主要是为了让学生了解可以运用学过的大写字母来表示一些常见的缩略词或缩写形式。老师也可以补充一些常见的缩略词。
For example:
T:Have you seen these abbreviations?Do you know what they stand for?Now let's look at the pic tures and abbreviations and discuss in groups.
1.小组讨论,展示答案。
2.展示各小组课前收集的缩略词,看看哪组收集得多。
3.教师在屏幕上多展示一些缩略词,让同学们多了解一些。
本课我们主要学习了red,white,yellow,black等表示颜色的单词,S—Z八个字母的读音及大小写形式,还学习了“What color is it?It's red.”两个句型。难点是准确而熟练地描述物体的颜色。在第二课时的学习中我们会继续使用这两个句型进行语言交际。
1.把Ss—Zz八个字母的大小写形式每个写5遍。
2.制作彩色字母卡片,并在卡片上写出本节课学习的句型。
1.What color is it?它是什么颜色的?
【用法透析】该句型结构为“What color +be +名词(代词)+?”用来问某物是什么颜色。
这是对颜色进行提问的特殊疑问句。what是疑问代词,可放在名词前修饰说明名词(color),该句的主语是it,所以动词用单数is,若主语是复数的,则动词用are。该句答语为“It's/They're+颜色.”
2.It's black.它是黑色的。
【用法透析】it是代词,指代前面所提到的东西或人。
【误区警示】注意:its易与it's混淆。it's是it is的缩略式,意思是“它是”,用时要注意以下几点:
①在句首时it's 和it is 两者可以通用。例如:
It's/It is a pen.它是一支钢笔。
That is a car.It's an English car.那是一辆汽车,它是一辆英国生产的汽车。
②作肯定回答时,在Yes之后只能用it is,而不能用it's。如:
—Is this a pen?这是只钢笔吗?
Starter Unit 3 What color is it?
blue,green,red,yellow,black,white,brown,purple,color
What color is it?
It's red...
七年级英语上册课件(篇3)
一、作者简介
巴金,现代著名作家。原名李尧棠,字芾甘,19生于四川成都。建国后曾任中国文联副主席,中国作家协会副主席、主席,作协上海分会主席,上海文联主席,《收获》主编。主要作品有:长篇小说《爱情三部曲》(《雾》《雨》《电》),《激流三部曲》(《家》《春》《秋》);中篇小说《憩园》,《寒夜》;散文集《保卫和平的人们》,《友谊集》,《随想录》;散文、小说、特写集《新声集》,《赞歌集》,还有不少短篇小说、童话、杂文等。
二、《繁星》的写作背景
这篇文章选自巴金的《海上杂记》。1923年,19岁的巴金和三哥毅然冲破封建家庭的樊笼到了上海,南京,考入东南大学附中补习班。在学习期间,参加了一些社会活动,著名的五卅运动对他的影响较大,他的民主思想得到进一步发展。1927年1月15日,他乘法国轮船昂热号离沪赴法,卫惠林同行,先后同船的中国学生计9人。他去法国是为了学习经济学,向西方找真理,进一步研究无政府主义理论,考察欧洲的社会活动。法国既是无政府主义的发源地,也是当时欧洲的政治流放者的庇护所。2月18日,昂热号邮轮抵达马赛。19日巴金抵达巴黎。在邮船航行期间,巴金撰写了《海上杂记》38则。《繁星》是其中的一篇游记,写于1927年1月。
七年级英语上册课件(篇4)
一、教学目标
1、知识目标
(1)学习并掌握描述天气的词汇:rainy、windy、sunny、cloudy、snowy
(2)掌握句型结构:
—How is the weather(in +地点)?/What’s the weather like?(in +地点)?
—It’s rainy/windy/sunny/cloudy/snowy.2、能力目标
学会使用本单元的单词和句型询问天气并作出恰当的应答。
3、情感目标
(1)通过小组合作完成任务,培养学生团结合作的意识。
(2)通过谈论天气,了解一些地理常识。
(3)通过学习天气,培养学生的乐观积极向上的心态。
二、教学重难点
1、教学重点
(1)描述天气的词汇:rainy、windy、sunny、cloudy、snowy
(2)掌握句型结构:
—How is the weather(in +地点)? /What’s the weather like?(in +地点)?
—It’s rainy/windy/sunny/cloudy/snowy.2、教学难点
(1)名词转换形容词的构词法:sun—sunny、rain—rainy、wind—windy、cloud—cloudy、snow—snowy
(2)国外城市的读音和拼音
三、教学方法
教师采用任务型教学方法让学生主动参与小组合作探究,迅速有效地开展各项活动。
四、教学辅助工具:黑板、多媒体设备
五、教学过程:
1、热身运动
(1)师生共唱“rain? go? away”, 活跃课堂气氛。
(2)做个模拟下雨的游戏,引出本课有关天气的话题。
2、导入生词:
(1)以weather为中心词,让学生进行头脑风暴,回忆有关天气的词汇,然后观看PPT图片导入本课新单词:rainy、windy、sunny、cloudy、snowy
(2)教师带读,让学生熟记单词。
3、呈现句型
(1)给出句型结构:
—How is the weather(in +地点)? /What’s the weather like?(in +地点)?
—It’s rainy/windy/sunny/cloudy/snowy.(2)分别用两个句型进行游戏比赛,让学生在游戏中反复巩固新句型和新知识点。
4、听力练习,课本37页,1b5、PPT呈现中国气象地图,让学生小组讨论并抽代表上讲台模拟天气预报,并作出评价。
6、课堂总结:总结本节课所学单词和句型
7、课堂练习
8、情感升华
六、教学反思
1、课堂板书设计得应该更能适合本节课的总结这一环节,以后注意板书的书写
2、课堂口语需加强,有些突发状况还不能立即用英语表达。
七年级英语上册课件(篇5)
单词水平测试七
班级 ______________ 姓名 ______________ 分数 ______________
1. French is one of the o _______________ languages in Canada.
2. If you taste the sea water, you’ll find it s _______________.
3. He has broken the agreement by not doing the work he p _______________.
4. I know you are very busy, but if you can m _______________ to come on Saturday afternoon, I shall be very thankful.
5. A good p _______________ is very important for a teacher of English who teaches small children.
6. A national conference will be held next _______________ (周三) to discuss the economic problems.
7. The hostess takes pride in careful _______________ (准备) of special dishes.
8. While they were away from home, they put all their valuable in the bank, just for _______________ (安全).
9. Mr. Smith turns lawyer but Mr. Brown _______________ (仍然) a worker.
10. Susan is talkative, but she never talks to _______________ (陌生人) .
11. I can’t go to the party, but I’m going to have some flowers d _______________ for her birthday.
12. The picture shows four g _______________, great grandfather, grandfather, parents and baby.
13. My English teacher always e _______________ me when I meet with difficulties.
14. The c _______________ made me worn out when I reached the top of the mountain.
15. I’ll have to buy a pair of t _______________ to match my new T-shirt.
16. Robin is a cold-blooded killer; he has _______________ (谋杀) a lot of people.
17. The worst part of the divorce was the _______________ (分离) from his three children. He wanted to be with them.
18. The show had a very large audience, _______________ (范围) from children to grandparents.
19. Do you think the teaching in _______________ (私人的) schools is better than in state schools?
20. Your plan sounds good, and it you raise the plan at the meeting I’ll _______________ (支持) you.
单词水平测试八
班级 ______________ 姓名 ______________ 分数 ______________
1. My brother enjoys c _______________ stamps.
2. You seem to have a fever. Let me take your t _______________.
3. The air around the earth is called a _______________.
4. What he said e _______________ me greatly and I made up my mind to continue learning.
5. The manager can speak several f _______________ languages.
6. Dreams are just _______________ (记忆) to be.
7. Nowadays most people use paper _______________ (手帕) .
8. Nie Haishen and Fei Jun long have become _______________ (熟悉的) faces to millions of fans of space travel.
9. Not surprisingly, praise usually makes children _______________ (提高) greatly.
10. The boy spoke in a very low voice _______________ (承认) he had broken the glass.
11. When a soldier meets an officer, the soldier often s _______________ him.
12. When the crops are r _______________, they are ready to be harvested.
13. The fridge does not f _______________ very well; you’d better get it repaired.
14. I know you are very busy. Would you mind s _______________ me a few minutes?
15. A bicycle is far more c _______________ than a car or a bus in busy cities.
16. The car accident has caused _______________ damage to Mary’s eyesight; she will not be able to see things for the rest of her life.
17. Hand _______________ () is the small bags that you carry with you when you are traveling on a plane.
18. The boy was happy to see many colorful _______________ () go up into the sky.
19. Although the painting looked old, it’s really a _______________ ().
20. One of his _______________ () is to become the CEO of the international company.
Key
单词水平测试七
1. official 2. salty 3. promised 4. manage 5. pronunciation 6. Wednesday 7. preparation 8. safety 9. remains 10. strangers 11. delivered 12. generations 13. encourages 14. climbing 15. trousers 16. murdered 17. separation 18. ranging 19. private 20. support
单词水平测试八
1. collecting 2. temperature 3. atmosphere 4. encouraged 5. foreign 6. memories 7. handkerchiefs 8. familiar 9. improve 10. admitting 11. salutes 12. ripe 13. function 14. sparing 15. convenient 16. permanent 17. luggage 18. balloons 19. fake 20. ambitions
七年级英语上册课件(篇6)
教学内容:Unit 6 Do you like bananas?
教材解读
本单元主要讨论各种食物以及喜欢或不喜欢某种食物;询问某人是否喜欢某种食物及回答;会描述一日三餐,会合理搭配一日三餐。
like的一般现在时、一般疑问句及肯、否定回答;肯定句和否定句。
通过本单元的学习,认识到在平日饮食中要做到不挑食、不偏食、合理饮食。
教学目标
一、知识与技能
1.掌握基本词汇:food、banana、hamburger、tomato、broccoli、French fries、strawberry、orange、ice cream、salad。
2.掌握句型:Do you like bananas? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.二、过程与方法
通过听说读写等任务型活动,熟练应用所学单词和动词词组。
三、情感态度和价值观
认识并了解各种食物,能分清水果和蔬菜并能认识到水果和蔬菜对人体有益。通过询问对方是否喜欢某食物来引起话题。
教学重点
基本单词、词汇和句型。
教学难点
1.认识并掌握重点词汇。
2.能流利地与对方开展关于食物喜好的对话。教法导航
采用任务型教学途径并配以多媒体辅助教学,同时考虑学生的不同层次采取分层递进的教学方法。
学法导航
让学生在游戏的情景中感受到轻松愉悦、民主和谐的环境气氛,学生积极主动参与,从而产生了强烈的求知愿望,增强学习兴趣。
教学准备
PPT、关于食物的图片。教学过程
Step 1: Greetings.Greet the students as usual.Step 2: Revision Show the students pictures and ask:What’s this? It’s a soccer ball.Do you have a soccer ball? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.Do you like it? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.Step 3: New words Show the students some food and ask:
2What’s this? It’s a hamburger.Do you like it? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.What are these? They’re bananas.Do you like bananas? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.运用图片和对话教学单词:hamburger、banana、tomato、broccoli、French fries、strawberry、orange、ice cream、salad,并运用这些单词进行对话。
Step 4: Pair work Work in pairs and try to match the words with the pictures of 1a.Step 5: Listening 1b Listen and number the conversations.After listening, show the dialogue on the screen and get the students to practice the conversations, and then make their own conversations.Step 6: Listening Listen and circle the food you hear.First get the students to check their answers in groups and then report their answers.Step 7: Listen again Listen again and fill in the blanks.I like hamburgers.Do you like hamburgers? Yes, I do.Do you like______? No, I don’t like ______.Let’s have _______.Oh, no.I don’t like_________.Step 8: Group work Make a food survey in groups by asking: Do you like...? Then fill in the blanks to complete the form.How many students like hamburgers? How many students like bananas? Step 9: Summary Let’s sum what we have learned this class.Words:banana, hamburger, tomato, ice cream, salad, strawberry.Sentences:Do you like hamburgers? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.Step 10: Homework 1.Remember the words in this class.2.Practise the dialogue in pairs.课堂作业
1.写出下列名词
(1)汉堡 ____________(2)西红柿 _____________(3)沙拉 ____________(4)草莓 ____________(5)梨 ____________(6)牛奶 __________(7)面包 __________(8)冰激凌 _________2.根据句意完成句子
(1)A:_______ you like salad? B:No, I _______./Yes, I ______.(2)I __________(喜欢)hamburgers.(3)_____________(你喜欢)hamburgers?(4)____________(我们吃)strawberries.参考答案:
1.(1)hamburger(2)tomato(3)salad(4)strawberry(5)pear(6)milk(7)bread(8)ice cream
2.(1)Do, don’t, do(2)like(3)Do you like(4)Let’s教学反思
这节课以学生的日常生活为话题,用丰富多彩的实物和图片激发学生的学习兴趣,学生踊跃参加课堂活动,效果很好。
七年级英语上册课件(篇7)
七年级上册语文知识点教案第一课
开学第一课
欢迎大家来到崭新的语文课堂,上次我们已经接受了小初中衔接的辅导,同学们拿到这本七年级上的语文课本也有很长时间了,已经翻阅过的请举手?你们感觉初中语文和小学语文有什么不同的地方?
今天这节课,我们先不进入我们的课文学习,我们不妨先进行一场进入初中语文课堂的的欢迎仪式,或者说是语文学习的启动仪式。这场欢迎仪式将分为三个主题:一、欢迎大家来到语文大课堂;二、欢迎大家来到语文大乐园;三、确定语文学习的目标。
切入主题之前,我首先要讲一下学习上的要求:
⒈准备四本本子:
①笔记本(学习日志):每一天都记号日期,记下错题、基础字词知识、上课要求、作业要求、课堂重点内容,来不及先记书上,课后整理,课下反反复复多回顾。
②作业本③听写默写本④作文本⑤课余读书摘抄本 读书札记
⒉准备好语文学习工具书:《现代汉语词典》 《古汉语常用字字典》 商务印书馆
⒊上课要求:
①双手放桌上
②除规定的讨论朗读时间外,保持教室安静,不讲和上课内容无关的话,树立公共课堂的公共意识,上课不认真不守纪律由课代表扣分记入期末总评成绩
③主动答疑:课上完之后,都可以到办公室提出疑问。
⒋作业要求:
按时完成作业,字写端正,第二天到校立即上交小组长,没有做完的(包括听默写没有通过)中午到办公室检查,完成后回家
预习:字词摘录、课文熟读、思考课后问题
一、欢迎大家来到语文大课堂
我们看到幻灯片上特别凸显了这个“大”字,所谓海纳百川,有容乃大,语文两个字的解释是:语言和文字以及语言和文学。它有一个很大的彰显其特色的学习范围,你的视野会变得非常开阔。
初中语文的学习内容:
⒈课文:
现代诗歌、现代散文、民间传说、说明文(科学技术、经济社会)、新闻通讯、人物传记、小说节选、微型小说、文言文、古典诗词。
人物分析、语言分析、情感分析、段落分析、语义分析、自我启发和感悟
⒉语言文字基础:
现代文:注音、字形、多音字、成语、熟语、造句、词义、句型、修辞、语法、标点符号。
文言文、古诗词:文言实词、文言虚词、文言句式、通假字、古今异义
⒊写作:以记叙、抒情、议论文章为主
以上这些是我们三年系统性的学习要接触的内容,由此可见第一即是内容范围上的大,跨越古今、国别,现代性、古典性、启蒙性、社会性相杂糅。第二则是学习效用之大,小学时你们的老师肯定说过,学好语文就意味着为其他学科的审题解答奠定基础,语言文字是人类沟通交流最基本的条件,在一些思想家比如卢梭看来,语言文字认识和接受的不平等是人类不平等的起源之一,语言被划为了贵族语言和平民语言,文字只有少数人才能掌握,导致了人类的贵贱有别,而我们现代教育的语文学习即是要打破这种不平等,要每个人都掌握相同的语言文字运用才能,获得人类文明中平等的认知权、沟通权和思考权。
二、欢迎大家来到语文大乐园
下面我们来继续探讨语文学习的第二个主题,我们学习语文的概念,不仅仅局限在简单地阅读分析课文,写命题考场作文,以及反复的做题上,这是理科的学习方法。语文学习在课堂外有很大的延伸空间,这就是所谓的大乐园主题。学习应该是充满乐趣的,我们应该提倡一种快乐语文的学习方式,这些乐趣总的体现在:
⒈阅读的乐趣
上课,完成作业,只是我们看到的学习的表面,学好语文,离不开阅读大量的文字,阅读应该与我们的生活密切联系,一本课外的好书可以提前几年提升你的知识境界,可以更新你的知识含量,21世纪一份报纸一周的信息量比18世纪人类一生掌握的信息量还多。你们不用抱着学会什么的任务心态去阅读,要利用课余非学习的时间,仅仅是捧起一本书,随意的翻开,不用怕读不懂,第一遍不懂,多读几遍肯定就会有自己的理解。抄下你感到有意义的句子,当你确实有了很深的感悟想要抒发的话,写一篇读后感是水到渠成的事。
有这么一个一个故事,俄国作家契诃夫写过一篇短篇小说叫做《打赌》,讲的是一次晚会上,银行家和一个年轻的律师打赌,律师将在一间小屋里囚禁,“规定在十五年间他无权跨出门槛,看见活人,听见人声,收到信件和报纸。允许他有一样乐器,可以读书、写信、喝酒和抽烟。跟外界的联系,根据契约,他只能通过一个为此特设的小窗口进行,而且不许说话。他需要的东西,如书,乐谱,酒等等,他可以写在纸条上,要多少给多少,但只能通过窗口。”按照约定,15年后,他将得到银行家的大半财产。15年过去了,年轻人除了每天要求外界给他送书,始终没有走出过屋子一步,到达规定日期的前一天,银行家反悔了,他决定在深夜潜入屋子,杀死那个年轻律师,守住自己的财富。一根将要燃尽的蜡烛旁边,他看到已经骨瘦如柴的年轻人正熟睡着,旁边放着一封刚刚写好的信:信中说,他感谢企业家,十五年来他读了许多书,这些知识将是他终身用不尽的财富,他还明白了许多道理。他决定不再要企业家的财产,他将于明天拂晓前破窗而出,自动毁约。一起来听一下信中的一段话:
十五年来,我潜心研究人间的生活。的确,我看不见天地和人们,但在你们的书里我喝着香醇的美酒,我唱歌,在树林里追逐鹿群和野猪,和女人谈情说爱……由你们天才的诗人凭借神来之笔创造出的无数美女,轻盈得犹如臼云,夜里常常来探访我,对我小声讲述着神奇的故事,听得我神迷心醉。在你们的书里,我攀登上艾尔布鲁士和勃朗峰的顶巅,从那里观看早晨的日出,观看如血的晚霞如何染红了天空、海洋和林立的山峰。我站在那里,看到在我的上空雷电如何劈开乌云,像人蛇般游弋;我看到绿色的森林、原野、河流、湖泊、城市,听到塞王的歌唱和牧笛的吹奏;我甚至触摸过美丽的魔鬼的翅膀,它们飞来居然跟我谈论上帝……在你们的书里我也坠入过无底的深渊,我创造奇迹,行凶杀人,烧毁城市,宣扬新的宗教,征服了无数王国……
你们的书给了我智慧。不倦的人类思想千百年来所创造的一切,如今浓缩成一团,藏在我的头颅里。我知道我比你们所有的人都聪明。
我也蔑视你们的书,蔑视人间的各种幸福和智慧。一切都微不足道,转瞬即逝,虚幻莫测,不足为信,有如海市蜃楼。虽然你们骄傲、聪明而美丽,然而死亡会把你们彻底消灭,就降消灭地窖里的耗子一样,而你们的子孙后代,你们的历史,你们的不朽天才,将随着地球一起或者冻结成冰,或者烧毁。为了用行动向你们表明我蔑视你们赖以生活的一切,我放弃那两百万,虽说我曾经对它像对天堂一样梦寐以求,可是现在我蔑视它。为了放弃这一权利,我决定在规定期限之前五个小时离开这里,从而违反契约……
银行家最后放弃了杀他的打算,律师则在第二天早晨偷偷地离开了屋子。他的感悟虽然有些极端,但我们可以看到,真正的阅读是充满无限吸引力的。
你们处在中考的学习压力下,课堂语文学习会以考试做题为中心,这很容易让你们沦为考试工具,失去思想和智慧的发展潜能,为了开阔视野,我们更需要培养阅读兴趣,把读书当做信仰一般,这样,不久的将来,你们既能升入好的高中,同时也会装满丰富的思想,让自己的人生充满更多乐趣。
⒉电影、音乐的乐趣
一本好电影比我们的课文有更深的心灵震荡,一首好的歌词会有诗一样的语言,让我们获得更美的文字体验。
三、确定语文学习的目标
阅读、欣赏电影和音乐,提升的是我们的文艺素养和气质,我希望这是你们一辈子都离不开的事。但是三年,我们有一个短期的目标,每一学期的期末考,三年后的中考,要检查你掌握的知识能力,决定你能不能升入杭二、学军、杭高这样的全国名校。所以我们的学习目标是这样的:掌握良好的阅读文章能力、文字运用及写作能力;会背诵一定篇目的古诗词、文章;掌握现代文、文言文的基础字词知识。我的要求是:把我当做你们的向导,跟着我,多思考,把每一次课当做一步楼梯,一步一步的走,认认真真地上好课,做好作业,背诵好文字,持之以恒,千万不要落下。
确定课代表、组长
作业:预习第一篇课文
我的语文学习目标
我最喜欢的一本书
我期待一个什么样的语文老师
学习语文的方法
1、注重日常积累:语文考验的是自己肚中的墨水,若是自己没有一定知识累积的话,语文成绩自然不高。所以想要提升语文成绩,平时更应该注重诗词好句的积累。
2、学会理解文章:通过理清文章的结构层次,明确课文的内在逻辑,把结构层级作为记忆线索,形成知识网络,更能方便记忆。
3、学会观察周围:写作是源于生活的,最打动人的往往是细节之处。所以平时要多观察生活,写作时多做细节描写,才能真正为作文进行润色,让老师能眼前一亮。
学习语文的技巧
1、学习未动,兴趣先行
2、务学与求道
3、自信是成功的第一秘诀
4、态度决定一切
5、不强调进步
6、练就过硬的本领是学习的根本目的
7、会玩、会偷懒、然后会学
8、考试、分析考试结果、做出下一步计划、调整自己
9、学习别人
七年级英语上册课件(篇8)
牛津5B:Unit 1
《牛津小学英语5B》Unit 1 A New Term
一、教学内容
《义务教育课程标准实验教科书 牛津小学英语》5B第一单元第一教时(Part B and Part C)
二、教学目标
1、能正确地听、说、读、写单词
Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday, Friday, Chinese, Science,
Computer Studies.
2、能正确地理解并应用句型What day is it today ?It’s…
What lessons do you have in the … We have …
3、能用所学单词、句型问答并初步感知句型Welcome back to school. Nice to see you.
三、教学重点
正确应用所学的句型问答
四、教学难点
单词的四会掌握
五、教具准备
自制课表、录音、投影
六、教学过程
A. Free talk
1.Greetings
用“Happy New Year!’’ “Welcome back to school!” “How are you?’’等日常交际用语进行问答,复习并导入新知
2.Revision
复习“I like English .What do you like?’’ “Do you like…?’’ “How about you?’’等所学句型,渗透新知
3.Present “Science,Social Science, PE, Computer Studies’’
方法:延续以上对话引出。通过实物直观呈现,在学生理解的基础上,进行单词教学(教师先范读,让生静听、模仿跟读。可通过抢答、试拼等进行巩固)为避免单词教学的枯燥,可将单词放入句型中操练,也可为新句型的教学做个铺垫。
例如: I like Science. What subject do you like? Oh you like Art. Me,too. How about you/ And you? …
师生示范一例,生生操练并问答表演。
B. Presentation and practice
1.Learn “Monday”
教师自由谈话引出,例如:Oh, someone likes PE, but someone likes English…Today is “Monday”(出示自制课表),师重复该单词,生静听、模仿跟读。延续以上对话,引出:“What lessons do we have today? ”
生听、模仿。
2.Present “What lessons do we have in the morning?”
引导学生用“We have┅”回答
1)师问,让学生熟练回答。
2)学生试问,师帮助纠正读音。
3)在会读的基础上操练并进行实际运用,师生先示范,后让学生自由练习运用。
3.Learn “Tuesday, Wednesday…Friday”
方法:渗透新句型“What day is it today? It’s…”
例如:What day is it today?
It’s Thursday.
为避免单词教法的重复,在新单词的引入时还可以用让学生试读的方法,单词的拼读可通过竞赛、游戏等方法以激发学生的兴趣。同时也可加入本课所学的句型“What lessons do we have in the morning?” “We have┅”,使对话的情景更为真实,也起到了复习的作用。
C. Practice
1)教师利用自制的课表进行连锁操练:
A:What day is it today?
B: It’s Thursday.
A: What lessons do you have in the morning?
B: We have┅
B: What day is it today?
C: It’s Friday.
….
2) 师利用投影进行有意义的操练,图文结合。
3)利用挂图,生生问答,检查表演。
D、Assign homework
1.朗诵并抄写要求会的单词、词汇和句型。
2.完成练习册A、B部分。
一、教学内容
《义务教育课程标准实验教科书 牛津小学英语》5B第一单元第二教时(Read and say 和part F)
二、教学目标
1、能正确地理解、掌握对话内容,并能朗读、初步表演对话。
2、能正确地听、说、读写单词a subject. Interesting, a week 和句型What subjects do you like ? I like…
3、能正确地运用对话中的日常交际用语Nice to see you. I hape we have more. How about you?
4、在掌握重点句型的基础上,通过本课学习培养学生的语言实际运用能力。
三、教学重点
能正确理解对话内容并能朗读和初步表演对话。
四、教学难点
能比较流畅的朗读对话,并能在掌握对话的基础上分角色表演。
五、教具准备
录音、图片、多媒体
六、教学过程
A.Revision
1.Play a game: “反口令”游戏
2.Free talk.
A: I have a … What do you have?
B:I have a …
A:I like going sopping. What do you like?
C:I like …
A:I often going shopping on Sundays. Is it Sunday today?
Ss:No,it isn’t. It’s Monday.
3.复习前一课所学有关的单词,通过图、词闪现,师生问答,或个别问答。
A: What day is it ?
B: It’s …
4. Sing a song 生初步感知、熟悉歌词及旋律。
B.Presentation
1.教学句型“What subjects do you like?” “I like…”
(由对话自然引出)T: We are having an Engilsh lesson. Do you like English?
Ss: Yes, …/No, …(师帮助学生回答)
T: What subjects do you like?(生跟读,出示板书)
S1:I like …(师作提示)
2.Teach: How about you?
师指明一名学生:How about you? 生自然地理解并作答,师可稍作提示“I like…”
3.Drill
a.师问生,直观呈观句型运用的情景,为学生自己开口说作铺垫。
b.同桌互问,要求学生适当加入问候语,真实运用语言。
c.走下坐位与学生交流,既检查学生的掌握情况,又给了学生说的场地、机会。
4.Learn “interesting”
1).教师可由以上的对话What subjects do you like? Do you like PE?生回答Yes, I do.师可引入Yes, it’s interesting.
新单词的呈现时师可放慢速度,让学生感知读音后再开口,为了使学生明确意思可在单词卡下面写出中文给学生参照。
2).Say a rhyme
根据不同的学生不同的爱好这一特点,由生描述I like …,It’s interesting .一方面训练 interesting,同时也复习前面所学各种科目的单词。师总结出rhyme.
English, English, A, B, C.
Maths, Maths, one, two, three.
Chinese, Chinese, write and read.
Art, Art, draw and sing.
PE, PE, run and swim.
C.Listen, read and say.
1.Present “I hope we have more ” “a week”
(师述引出)I like PE, do you like PE? Who like PE, please hands up. But we have only two in a week. I hope we have more.
单词week让学生多听几遍,读音可与 “need”比较读。也可提问:How many days are there in a week? 检查学生理解程度。在引入I hope we have more 后可改动课表, 如增加二节课,帮助学生理解。单词和句型的读应放在听清发音之后。
2.Listen and answer
课文对话分成两部分,降低难度,听一半对话后回答:
1).What day is it today?
2).What lessons do they have in the morning?
检查后继续听并完成句子:
What do Su Hai and Su Yang like? Su Hai likes and Su Yang likes .
3.Read the text by yourselves then together.
4.Read in roles
D. Practice
1.Look ask and answer
2.Do a survey
可借助F部分的表格,师先示范,让学生明确句型运用的场合,再相互问答。作记录后上前回答并介绍。
E.Homework
听录音,朗读并表演对话。
四人一组自编或改编对话。
一、教学内容
《义务教育课程标准实验教科书 牛津小学英语》5B第一单元第三教时(Part D, E, F and Part G, H)
二、教学目标
1.进一步掌握本单元的单词、句型达到能熟练运用的程度。
2.通过有针对性的操练,训练重点句型和难点,学生能用所学句型进行情景对话和交流。
3.了解元音字母O在开音节词中的读音。
4.能演唱本课英语歌曲。
三、教学重点
1.进一步掌握本单元的单词、句型达到能熟练运用的程度。
2、通过有针对性的操练,训练重点句型和难点,学生能用所学句型进行情景对话和交流。
四、教学难点
较熟练地掌握与运用所学句型及有关星期的单词。
五、教具准备
挂图、录音机、实物投影。
六、教学过程
A: Sing a song
1.Listen to the tape
听录音,投影歌词,学生熟悉旋律。试记歌词。
2.Sing after the tape
B: Free talk and revision
T:Good morning, class. Nice to see you.
Ss: Nice to see you.
T: I like running on Sunday morning. Do you like running?
S1:Yes, I do./ No, I don’t.
T: He likes PE, so he likes running.
What subject do you like?
S2: I like science.
T: How many science lessons do you have in a week?
S2: We have two. I hope we have more.
T: Excuse me .Do you have science today?
What day is it today?
Ss: It’s Friday.
T: What lesson do you have in the afternoon?
Ss:…
3.叫一学生走下坐位摹仿教师与其余学生交流。
4.利用挂图,操练句型 “What subject do you like ?”
I like … How about you?
I like …
先出示1幅图,师生试说后出示对话内容,其余挂图出示后生生操练再检查。
C: Look and read.
1.师引导学生读,扫除障碍,大致了解图意。
2.学习单词“trick” “minus”, 生猜其意并试读。
3.同桌问答,熟练地朗读对话。
4.你知道其中的窍门吗?用同样的方法来出题,自编对话。
例如:I like Maths very much. It’s┅
What’s 654 minus 456?
It’s ┅
D: Design a timetable
1.师出示自制的课表操练句型。
How many subject do you have this morning?
We have ┅
How many Chinese lessons do you have in a week?
We have ┅
What subject do you like?
I like┅
What lesson do you have on Wednesday?
We have┅
2. Make a new dialogue in pairs.
3. Action.
4. Design a timetable you like.
1).师示范(可利用科目粘贴的方式):选择星期几,再边问边选科目粘贴。
2)小组合作,注意用英语问答。
3)上台演示并作介绍。
S1: Today is ┅
The first lesson is┅
T: Do you have any questions to ask?
S2:What subject do you like?
S1:I like ┅
S3:Do you ┅
E: Listen and repeat.
1.利用卡片呈现单词,可加入以前所学的单词认读,如,black,happy,hat,rabbit,after,class,basketball,dance,clock,coffee,doctor,hot┅
2.同桌交流,互读,体会读音相同和不同之处。
3.Read after the tape.
4.归纳出clock, coffee, doctor,hot的共同音标,后出示图,师生共同看图说话:The hot coffee near the clock is for the doctor.
F. Homework
1.抄写本单元所学单词、词组和句型,要求能默写。
2.能熟读并会表演Read and act .
3.自由分组编演小对话。
4.调查学生的兴趣、爱好,自制合理课表。
Unit2 A telephone call (第一教时)
一、教学目标:
1、能正确地听、说、读、写单词 a headache, bad , a cough ,got, a fever , a cold
2、能正确地听、说、读单词 a toothache , an earache , a backache , a stomach ache
3、能正确地理解并运用句型 What’s wrong with you? I’ve got…
4、能初步熟悉歌谣。
二、教学重点及难点:
1、能正确地朗读和书写本课时要求掌握的单词。
2、能正确地理解和运用句型What’s wrong with you? I’ve got….
三、课前准备:
1、本课所教单词的图片。
2、录音机和磁带。
四、教学过程:
A、课前热身
Game: Touch your nose/eyes/head/ear/tooth并导入back stomach
B. Free talk
T: How are you?
S: Fine thank you. /Not so good
当有学生回答Not so good 时,教师关切地询问What’s the matter?
What’s wrong with you? 并用手势引导学生回答。
(What’s the matter? 在4A出现过教师可告诉学生What’s the matter?和What’s wrong with you?的意思一样.)
板书:What’s wrong with you? 生跟读
在生回答后,师:I’m sorry to hear that. I hope you get better soon.[板书,生跟读]
C. Presentation and practice.
1、Teach: toothache
a. 师与一生表演呈现
T: How are you?
S: Not so good.
T: What’s wrong with you?
S: I’ve got a toothache. (托腮作痛苦状)
T: I’m sorry to hear that. I hope you get better soon.
b. 师出示图片并配以单词 a toothache
生跟读:a toothache a toothache I’ve got a toothache.(板书:I’ve got a….)
c. 练习What’s wrong with you? I’ve got a…. I’m sorry to hear that. I hope you get better soon.
师问生答 生问生答
2、同法教学单词 earache backache headache stomachache
并启发学生总结此类单词的词尾特点:后缀-ache
3、学单词fever cold cough
4、听B部分录音并跟读
5、Say a rhyme
a.听录音,理解意思
b.听录音跟读
c.试着模仿改编,并朗诵.(替换high fever)
D操练句型及单词
1、整体操练
师出示图片问:What’s wrong with you?
要求生根据图片内容边做相应的动作边回答:I’ve got a……
T: I’m sorry to hear that. I hope you get better soon.
2、学生两人一组自编对话并表演
3、P18 Work in pairs
a.Picture1 师生问答
b.Picture 2-6 学生两人一组看图进行模仿练习。然后分角色进行表演。
E Assign homework
1、并抄写要求四会掌握的单词和词组。
2、运用所学的词组和句型自由交谈
Unit2 (第二教时)
一、教学目标:
1.能正确地听、说、读、写单词lunch , speak, feel
2.能初步理解并运用句型How do you feel now? I feel…..
3.能正确地听、说、读日常用语M ay I speak to…?This is …speaking .See you soon
4.能熟练诵读本课的歌谣。
二、教学重点和难点:
1.能正确朗读和书写本课的单词。
2.能熟练运用本课的句型。
三、课前准备:
1.本单元单词图片
2.两部玩具电话机
3.磁带 录音机
四、教学过程:
A. Revision
师生之间以free talk的形式复习句型What’s wrong with you?和本单元B部分的单词
T: Hello xxx How are you today?(出示图片 要求学生根据图片回答)
S: Not so good.
T: What’s wrong with you?
S: I’ve got a stomach ache
T: I’m sorry to hear that. I hope you get better soon.
S: Thank you.
2.生问师答 生问生答
B. Presentation and practice.
1. 师关切地询问刚才回答不舒服的学生:How do you feel now?
帮助学生回答I feel ill/ hot /tied…
T: I can get a glass of water for you
S: Thank you.
2、板书:How do you feel now?
I feel….
I can get a/some…for you.
生跟读数遍
3、看图编对话,练习并表演(教师逐一出示P7的图片)
C Read and say.
1、复习打电话(5A学过)并新授May I speak to …
May I speak to….
T: Hello, Is that Wang Bing?
S1: Yes, this is xxx
S2: No, this is Yu Wenjie.
T: Sorry, May I speak to Yang Jie?
帮助生答Hold on, please.并把电话递给Yang Jie
Yang Jie: Hello, this is Yang Jie speaking.
(板书speak May I speak to … This is …speaking)
2学生练习用May I speak to …打电话
3在此基础上,教师出示课文挂图并用语言直接导入:Helen is not at school She’s absent today She’s ill 引导学生理解absent的意思,然后指着挂图说 Helen is in her bedroom Su Yang is calling her.让学生理解第2句中her的意思
教师出示钟面,指针显示12:30 师:Su Yang calls her after lunch.帮助学生理解after lunch
4.听课文录音回答问题
What’s wrong with Helen?
a.听录音(P14)二遍
b.指名回答问题
c. Listen and repeat.
5.学习P15对话
a.师把钟面指针拨到4:35 问:What’s the time now?
S: It’s four thirty
T: Yes Classes are over. Su Yang calls Helen after school.
b. 看图听录音
c. 帮助学生理解still take any medicine
d. Listen and repeat.
6.教师安排学生整体听录音。模仿正确的语音语调学说对话。
7.情境表演,用玩具电话设置与课文内容相仿的情境。分角色表演本课会话内容。
D. Assign homework
1.听录音,朗读并表演对话
2.根据所学的对话内容自编或改编对话。
Unit 2 (第三教时)
一、教学目标:
1.复习本单元所学的词汇
2.进一步掌握句型How do you feel now ? I feel … I can get a/some…for you . 及 What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got a…
3.能正确地听、说、读、写句子 How do you feel now ? I feel … What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got …
4.能听懂、会说、会读日常交际用语 Sorry, Wrong Number
二、教学重点及难点:
能正确地听、说、读、写句子 What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got a … How do you feel , now? I feel ……
三、课前准备:
1.B部分单词卡片
2.录音机和磁带
3.准备一些医生看病用的道具
4.两台玩具电话机
四、教学过程:
B、A. Say a rhyme
1.用投影片出示英文儿歌《 I’m ill 》,让学生眼看录音机朗读
2.教师逐一出示单词卡片,让学生进行替换朗读。(复习单词)
C、B. Ask and answer
1.Revesien
教师再次出示单词卡片,与学生进行问答。
T:×××,What’s wrong with you ?
S:(根据图片内容)I’ve got a …
T: I’m sorry to hear that ? How do you feel , now ?
S: I feel …
T: I can get a /some … for you .
2. Practise in groups.
a. 小组活动,让学生根据图片内容进行同桌自由问答,要求说得正确、流利。
b. 小组比赛。
D、C. Read and act
1. 教师出示这部分内容的挂图。让学生听录音整体理解对话内容。并回答问题 What’s wrong with the woman ? 从而了解学生对对话的理解。
2. 学生跟读并朗读对话。
3. 在能熟练朗读对话的基础上,让学生两人一组扮演角色扮演对话。
E、D. Work in pairs
1. 学生自由朗读这部分对话。
2. 教师指名朗读,检查学生掌握情况。
3. 模仿对话,让学生进行游戏。教师把学生分成四人小组,要求其中三人写出一个七位数的电话号码交给老师,并在号码旁注上自己的姓名。没有给出电话号码的学生要记住其中一位同学的电话号码,然后打电话给该同学。注意提示学生别人打错电话时可以说 Sorry ,wrong number .
F、E. Assign homework
1. 朗读并抄写要求四会的单词,词汇和句型。
2. 用句型 What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got a … 和 How do you feel , now ? I feel … 进行笔头编对话各两组。
Unit 2 (第四课时)
一、教学目标:
1. 通过复习,要求学生能熟练地掌握本单元所学的有关疾病类词汇
2. 能熟练地在情景中运用本单元所学的句型和日常交际用语
3. 能进一步掌握句型 What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got … How do you feel now ? I feel …
4. 能初步了解字母O在闭音节单词中的读音
二、教学重点
能正确地听、说、读、写句型 What’s wrong with you ? 及其答语 I’ve got … 和 How do you feel , now ? 及其答语 I feel …
三、教学难点
能较熟练地掌握本单元所学的有关疾病类词汇
四、课前准备
1. 录音机和磁带,玩具电话机,医生用的一些道具,各种动物头饰
2. 单词图片
3.学生自制电话号码卡,放在桌上备用。
五、教学过程:
G、A. Free talk and revision
1. 教师一边报出一生的电话号码,一边拨打电话,该生就拿起玩具电话机和老师进行对话。
T: 722××××, Hello , may I speak to ××× ?
S: This is ××× speaking .
T: Hi , ×××, This is Miss Huang , How are you , today ?
S: I’m fine , thank you . / Not so good .
(当生答Not so good 时)T: What’s wrong with you ?
S: I’ve got a …
T: Oh , I’m sorry to hear that .
How do you feel , now ?
S: I feel …
T: I can got a / some … for you .
S: Thank you .
T: Not at all , See you soon .
(教师也可故意报错号码,让学生练习用Sorry ,wrong number )
2. 学生两人或三人一组模仿编对话并练习。
3. 小组比赛,看看哪一组表演得自然、流畅、正确。
H、B. Say a rhyme
让学生跟着录音机诵读,并练习自编儿歌。
I、C. Play a game
1. 教师创设情境:森林里有一家动物医院,里面有医术精湛的大象医生,老马医生,老虎医生和狮子医生。这两天,气温反常,许多小动物都生病了,都到医院去看医生,如果你是病人,该怎样去医院看医生呢 ?
2. 四位学生戴着大象,老马,老虎,狮子的头饰,身穿白大褂,手拿听诊器扮演医生,其他学生戴各种动物头饰扮演病人,到自己喜欢的医生处就诊。从而用 What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got a … Open your mouth and say “Ah” …等日常用语展开一段对话。
3. 教师巡视各组情况,进行及时表扬和纠正错误。
J、D. Listen and repeat
1. 教师逐个出示单词 brother , love , monkey , mother . 让学生认读
2. 让学生在多次朗读单词后找出它们的共同因素。即O发 |∧|
3. 听录音跟读句子 My mother and my brother love that fat monkey .
K、E. Assign homework
1. 抄写本单元所学的单词、词组和句型,并能默写。
2. 能够熟读并表演 Read and act 。
3. 根据实际生活情景自编对话,并表演对话。
Unit 3
一、教学内容
《牛津小学英语5B》 Unit 3 Hobbies(第一课时)
二、教学目标
1 能正确地理解、掌握对话内容,并能朗读、初步表演对话。
2 能正确地听、说、读、写单词:collect, a stamp, beautiful, a classmate, a ship, an animal。
3 能正确地运用对话中的词组和日常交际用语:take photos, Show us his stamps, please.
Here they are.
4 能正确地理解并运用句型Do you have any hobbies? Do you like…? Yes, I do.
No, I don’t. He/She likes…
5 能初步理解主语为第三人称单数时动词的变化形式。
6 初步熟悉歌曲:Hobbies。
三、教学重点
能正确理解对话内容并能朗读和初步表演对话。
四、教学难点
1 能比较流畅地朗读对话,并能在掌握对话的基础上分角色表演对话。
2 能初步理解主语为第三人称单数时动词的变化形式。
五、课前准备
1、一本有中国发行的船类和动物类邮票。
2、一架照相机。
3、Read and say 部分的投影片。
4、录音机和磁带。
六、教学过程
A Free talk
Eg: Good morning./How are you?/What day is it today?/What lessons do you have in the morning/afternoon?/What subject do you like? Do you like…?
B Presentation and practice
1 T:(出示一张印有花卉的邮票)What’s this? It’s a stamp.
Drill: stamp
T: Look at this stamp. What’s this?
Ss: It’s a flower.
T: Yes, it’s beautiful.
Drill: beautiful
2 T(出示一张印有船的邮票)Look. There’s a ship on the stamp. It’s a ship stamp.
Drill: ship
3 T:(出示几张印有动物的邮票)What’s this on the stamp?
Ss: There’s a dog on the stamp.
T: Yes, the dog is an animal. It’s an animal stamp.
(出示一张印有其他动物,如熊猫的照片,重复以上的对话)
T: They are animal stamps.
Drill: animal
4 T:(出示一本邮册)I like collecting stamps. Look, I have many stamps. They are beautiful. Do you like collecting stamps?
Ss: Yes, I do./No, I don’t.
Drill: collect/collect stamps.
5 T:(拿出一本相册)I like collecting photos.
(拿出照相机拍照)I like taking photos, too.
Drill: photo/take a photo.
Practise: The students say and do.(take a photo)
6 T:(请一男生和一女生到班前,教师指着女生对男生说)She’s your classmate.
(指全班学生)They are your classmates.
Drill: a classmate
7 Teaching of the sentence patterns.
1) T:(做游泳的动作)I like swimming. Do you like swimming?引导学生用Yes, I do./No, I don’t. I like…来回答。
2) 请一学生用I like…句型说出自己喜欢做的运动,教师逐一想全班:He/She likes…领说句型,学生跟读。
3) 教师出示Read and say部分的挂图进行句型介绍This is Yang Ling. She likes making clothes. Helen likes cooking and growing flowers.学生理解图片意思后模仿学说句型Yang Ling likes making clothes. Helen likes cooking and growing flowers.
4) 教师利用挂图进行问答练习,引出Does Yang Ling like making clothes? Yes, she does. Does Helen like taking photos? No, she doesn’t.领说句型。
C Read and say
1、The students look at the picture and listen to the tape.
2、The students listen to the tape and read after the tape.
3、The students read the dialogue themselves and the teacher gives some help.
4、The students read the dialogue in roles and act out the dialogue.
5、Ask several groups of students to act out the dialogue.
D Listen to a song: Hobbies
E Assign homework
1 Listen to the tape, read the dialogue and act out the dialogue.
2 Make a new dialogue according to the dialogue of the text.
Unit 3 (第二教时)
一、教学目标
1、能正确地听、说、读、写单词a coin和词组take photos, go shopping.
2、能正确地听、说、读词组make model ships, collect stamps, collect coins, grow flowers, keep goldfish, make clothes.
3、能唱本课英文歌曲。
二、教学重点
1、能正确地听、说、读、写单词a coin和词组take photos, go shopping.
2、能正确地听、说、读词组make model ships, collect stamps collect coins, grow flowers, keep goldfish, make clothes.
三、教学难点
1、能正确地听、说、读、写单词a coin 和词组take photos,go shopping.
2、能熟练运用本课所学的词组。
四、课前准备
1、画有动作的多媒体课件
2、B部分词组的动作图片和挂图
3、录音机和磁带
五、教学过程
A Free talk and motivation
1 Eg: Good morning!/How are you?/Nice to see you./Do you like…?Does he/she like…?
2 The students act out the dialogues.
3 Listen to the song: Hobbies, and sing after the song.
B Presentation
1 Present the pictures and say the phrases: take photos, make clothes, collect stamps.
2 T:(教师根据多媒体课件或动作图片提问)What’s he doing? He’s going shopping.通过教师自问自答引出make model ships, collect coins, keep goldfish,grow flowers等词组。
3 The students listen to the tape and read after the tape.
C Practice
1 把所有词组的图片贴在黑板上,教师说出一个词组并请一位学生指出黑板上相对的图片。
2 师生根据动作或图片进行问答练习,如Do you like going shopping?No,I don’t. Do you like keeping goldfish? Yes, I do.
3 教师引导学生看图,并用主语为第三人称单数的一般现在时叙述图片内容,如He likes making model ships. She likes making clothes.
4 学生同桌看图说话,自由操练词组。
D Consolidation
1 Listen and act or look and say.
(一学生发令,全班同学做动作,或一个学生演示一个动作,其他同学说出动作名称。)
2 Play the game: What’s missing?
(教师出示本单元所学的所有动词词组的图片,以最快的速度抽出一张,问学生What’s missing?学生说出被抽出图片的动词词组。)
3 Play the game: Chinese Whisper
(把学生分成小组,教师在每组第一位学生的耳边悄悄说出不同的单词或句子,让学生依次在下一位学生耳边轻声说出。然后请每组最后一位学生大声说出他/她所听到的单词或句子,说对的小组为优胜组。)
E Assign homework
1 read the phrases and copy the phrases.
2 Make some sentences with the phrases.
Unit 3 Hobbies(第三教时)
一、教学目标
1、能熟练掌握本单元所学的有关兴趣爱好词汇。
2、能熟练掌握句型Do you have any hobbies?及其答语Yes,I do.
3、能用句型I like…和He/She likes…,too.描述自己或他人的爱好和活动。
4、能用所学句型进行情景会话和交流。
二、教学重点
能正确地听、说、读、写句子Do you have any hobbies?及其答语Yes,I do.和I like…及He/She likes …,too.等句型。
三、教学难点
能正确运用Do you have any hobbies?及其答语Yes,I do.并能在具体情景中以口笔头或书面的形式进行交流。
四、课前准备
1、有关活动方面的多媒体课件或图片
2、录音机和磁带
3、学生自带一些有关自己兴趣爱好或活动的照片。
五、教学过程
A Sing a song
The students sing after the tape.
B Revision
1 Present the pictures of Part B with the CAI, the students say the eight phrases.
2 The teacher present the picture of Part B, the students talk about their hobbies with the sentence pattern: I like…..
3 Play a game
教师课前准备一些动作图片,一学生到讲台前挑选一种喜欢的动作图片,做图片上动作,其他学生猜他或她喜欢的活动:He/She likes …
C Ask and answer
1 Revision
Present the CAI and talk with the students.
Eg: S1: Do you have any hobbies?
T: Yes, I do. I like collecting stamps.
2 Practise in groups
1) Work in groups.
Eg: S1: Do you have any hobbies?
S2: Yes, I do. I like collecting/…
2) Compete in groups.
The students make sentences: Do you have any hobbies? Yes, I do. I like…He/She likes…,too.(The group which makes the most sentences is the winner.)
3) Make an interview.
The student interview his classmates with the topic: Hobbies.
Eg:S1: Do you have any hobbies?
S2:Yes, I do. I like making model ships/…
S1:(Point to another student) He likes making model ships, too. Right?
S2: Yes, he does./ No, he doesn’t. He likes taking photos/…
D Look,read and complete
1 The teacher present the pictures of PartD: This is a picture of Su Hai’s family. Su Hai and her family have some hobbies. The talk about the picture with the students, make the students know the meaning of the picture.
2 The students do the exercise.
3 Check the answer.
F Assign homework
1 Read and copy the words and sentences.
2 Make out a new dialogue.
Unit3 Hobbies(第四课时)
一、教学目标
1、通过复习,要求学生能熟练地掌握本单元所学的有关活动类词汇。
2、能熟练地在情景中运用本单元所学的句型和日常交际用语。
3、能进一步掌握句型Do you have any hobbies?及其答语Yes,I do.并能用I like…和He/She likes…,too.句型描述自己或他人喜欢的爱好和多动。
4、能初步了解字母u在单词中的读音。
二、教学重点
能正确地听、说、读、写句型Do you have any hobbies?及其答语Yes,I do.和I like…及He/She likes…,too.句式。
三、教学难点
能熟练地掌握本单元所学的有关活动类词汇。
四、课前准备
1、有关活动的多媒体课件或图片
2、E部分的教学挂图
3、录音机和磁带。
4、调查表
五、教学过程
A Free talk and revision
Eg: Good morning, class./I like…Do you have any hobbies?/He/She likes …Right?
B Sing a song
The students sing after the tape.
C Do a survey
1 Present the CAI or the picture of Part B, the students say the phrases.
2 Free talk.
The students talk about hobbies with each other.
3 Do a survey.
1) The teacher do a survey as a model.
Eg: T(Present the form)Do you have any hobbies?
S1:Yes,I do. I like…
T:(Fill the form)
2)The students do the survey in groups.
4 Sum up.
教师课前做一张统计表,抽取若干组学生,让学生汇报调查情况。
Eg: T: Can you tell me about your survey?
S: Yes. Five student like taking photos. One student likes making model ships.
taking photos 5
making model ships 1
D Read and act
1 T:(Present the picture) Now ,Boys and girls. Look at the picture. What does Liu Tao like? Can you guess?
Ss:…
(The student listen to the tape.)
2 Teach the words: water, every, aunt, carefully with the picture. Learn the dialogue.
3 Answer the questions:(Make sure the students understand the dialogue)
Eg:1)What is Liu Tao doing?
2)Who likes growing flowers, too?
3)Does Liu Tao water the trees and flowers every day?
4 Read the dialogue after the tape and act out the dialogue.
E Listen and repeat.
1 Play a game:
教师用多媒体课件快速展示图片,一闪即停,然后问学生:What’s missing?让学生看图后猜单词。
2 The students read the words together.
3 Sum up the common pronunciation.
4 Present the phonetic symbol and read after the teacher.
5 Read the sentence.
F Assign homework
1 Read the dialogue of Part E and try to act out it.
2 Make a new dialogue.
3 Do the exercise of the Exercise Book.
Unit 4《牛津小学英语5B》第四单元教案
课题: Unit 4 An English friend
课时: 本单元共4课时 本课为第1课时
课时目标:1. Four skills: fast high ,Does he/she…? Yes, he does. No, he doesn’t.
2. Three skills: speak loudly, run fast, jump high, dance beautifully, walk carefully, sit quietly
3. Require the Ss to use v. and adv. properly in a certain situation
教学内容和过程:
A. Warming up
1. Sing a song.
2. Free talk
B. Preparation
1. Greetings
2. Sing a song “Come on and join into the games”
C. Presentation and practice
1. jump high
a. Now, let’s do some exercise. Sun rise. Wave your arms. Shake your body. Stand up. Jump high etc. Run fast.
b. Ask a student to jump high. (put “jump high” on the Bb)
c. Read in pairs.
2. run fast
a. Let’s act! Run fast! (Put “run fast” on the Bb.)
b. Read in pairs!
3. speak loudly
a. I say you do. fast→run loudly→speak
b. Put “speak loudly” on the Bb. and read loudly.
c. You say s. do. cry loudly sing loudly
4. Teach dance beautifully, walk carefully, sit quietly in the same way
5. Listen to the tape and read after the tape
6. Hand out the cards to some students, ask the others to guess.
7. Show Ss some photos and talk about them. Does he run fast? Yes, he does. No, he doesn’t .Ask Ss try to say “Does he …?”
8. Talk about the picture in pair.
9. Make a dialogue and act it.
D. Consolidation
Do a survey
《牛津小学英语5B》第四单元教案
课题: Unit 4 An English friend
课时: 本单元共4课时 本课为第2课时
课时目标:1. Four skills: an e-mail, busy, town, age, usually, what does she usually do? He/she usually…
2. Three skills: I’m busy, we’re the same age
3. Require the students to read and act the dialogue
教学内容和过程:
A. Free talk
B. Preparation
3. Do some exercise!
4. Talk about the photos.
C. Presentation and practice
1. What does he/she usually…? He/she usually…
a. What do you usually do? I usually play football. What does he usually do? He usually…
b. Reading and practice.
2. Look at the picture and talk about it.
c. E-mail, surf the Internet, busy
What’s Wang Bing doing? Is he surfing the Internet? He’s busy.
d. town, age
Do you live in the city? No, I’m in a small town. Are you twelve? Yes, I am. And you? I’m twelve, too. You’re in the same age.
3. Listen to the tape, answer the question.
d. Does Wang Bing’s friend live in London?
e. How old is his friend?
f. Does he usually play football?
g. Does he play well?
4. Imitate!
5. Practice in groups.
D. Consolidation
6. Act the dialogue.
7. Talk about your own friends.
《牛津小学英语5B》第四单元教案
课题: Unit 4 An English friend
课时: 本单元共4课时 本课为第3课时
课时目标:1.进一步掌握本单元所学的动词词组
2.进一步掌握句型“What does…usually do…?” “He/She usually…”
能用该句型询问他人日常生活规律
3.通过本课学习能灵活区别运用Do…? Yes,…do./No,…don’t.
Does…? Yes,…does./No,…doesn’t.
教学用具:图片 录音机 投影
教学内容和过程:
A. Say a rhyme
3. Try to read. (投影呈现)
4. Listen to the tape.
5. Let’s say together.
B. Revision
5. 图片闪现,生说本单元所学的词组
6. Introduction
T: I usually read English books and watch TV on Sundays.
My brother usually does his homework…
My parents usually…
7. Do a survey in group
S1: What do you usually…?
S2: I usually…
S1: What do…
S3: I…
8. 从他人口中了解你的同学
e.g. SA: Excuse me ,B What does C usually do…
SB: She usually…
SA: Does D…?
SB: Yes,…/No,…
9. Play a game
a. 游戏目的:复习What does…? Does…?
b. 游戏准备:师准备各类图片
c. 方法:看看,问问,猜猜
一生看图,师生共猜(个别:Does…)
C. Ask and answer
8. 出示图片,师生示范一例
9. 同桌问答
10. 扩充对话,比比哪组说得好
D. Look and read
11. Look at the pictures
12. Listen to the tape, then repeat
13. Try to say (If you are the boy)
14. Describe
Use: He goes to school…
He has…
He likes…
15. 师提供类似的图片,出示关键词,生试说(同桌),比比谁说得既流利又正确。
E. Assign homework
1. 回顾本单元所学的词组,单词,试默
2. 用所学的句型描述你同学的日常生活,兴趣爱好
提示:go to school at seven
have six lessons everyday
have lunch at 11:10
like singing
…
《牛津小学英语5B》第四单元教案
课题: Unit 4 An English friend
课时: 本单元共4课时 本课为第4课时
课时目标:1. 通过复习,要求学生能熟练地掌握本单元所学的动词词组
2. 能熟练地在情景中运用本单元所学的句型及日常交际用语
3. 能进一步掌握句型Does…? Yes,…does./No,…doesnt.并能用What does …usually do…?询问他人日常生活规律
4.能初步了解字母u在单词中的读音
教学内容和过程:
A. Free talk and revision
T: I usually go shopping on Saturdays and Sundays.
Do you usually…?
S1: Yes, I do. / No, I don’t.
I usually play chess on Saturdays.
T: Does your mother work on Saturdays and Sundays?
S1: Yes, she does.
T: What does your father usually do in the evening?
S1: He usually watches TV and reads newspapers.
…
B. Say the rhymes
一生起说,齐说
C. Play a game
游戏目的:复习所学的动词词组并进行扩展,灵活运用
游戏方法:师说一副词,生做各种动作
e.g. cry /laugh/sing
You’re right. /great!
做错的:You’re wrong.
I’m sorry.
D. Read and act.
3. Look at the pictures, read after the tape in roles.
4. Change.
5. Try to ask and answer (Don’t look at your books.)
鼓励学生说,不一定要全面,完整,说一两句也行,还可以用自己的话说。
E. Listen and repeat
6. T writes some words on the blackboard or use some cards with the words.
7. Read together or ask someone to read.
3. 将单元按读音归类
[ju:] [u] [A]
4. Look at the picture, describe it then say “The puppet jumps and runs in the bus”
e.g. T: What’s this?
Ss: It’s a puppet.
T: Where is it?
Is it in the box?
Is it in the box?
Ss:…
F. Assign homework
1. 能熟练表演本课对话
2. 模仿Part A并结合重点句型自编对话(分小组进行)
Try to write a small passage (About your family member or your classmate)
Unit 5 Review and check
课时: 本单元共3课时 本课为第1课时
一.教学目标及重难点.
1. 复习及巩固动词与副词的搭配.
2. 复习问句:Does he/she…?yes, he /she does. No, he/she doesn’t.
二.教具准备:挂图,图片。
三.教学内容及过程.
Step 1.Revision
1. Greetings
2. Freetalk
1).Do you have any hobbies?
2).Do you like…?
3).Does he/she…?
4).What does he/she usually do…?
3. Answer quickly
The way: 当一个学生说出动词时,另一个学生快速的说出相应的副词.
Step 2.Look,read and write.
1. Show the pictures (1-4) and answer questions.
1).What does the girl/boy do?
2)do he/she…?
2. Read the sentences and fill in the blank.
3. Check the answers.
4. Show the pictures (5-8) and answer questions.
1).Does Miss Li like keeping goldfish?
2).Does Mr Black like making model ships?
3).Does Mrs Brown like cooking?
4).Does Mr Green like collecting stamps?
Step 3.Look and write.
1. Show the pictures of Part B.
2. Talk about the pictures.
3. Divide 8 groups and make dialogues
4. Check out.
Step 4 Consolidation
Assign homework: Finish Part A and B.
Read it and recite it.
课题: Unit 5 Review and check
课时: 本单元共3课时 本课为第2课时
一.教学目标
1. 能熟练运用“打电话”及课程的日常用语
2. 能正确掌握like + doing的形式
二. 教学重难点
目标1,2
三. 教学用具
挂图,实物,图片
四. 教学过程
Step1.Revision
1.Greetings
2.Free talk
May I speak to…?
This is …speaking.
I am sorry to hear that.
See you soon..
Sorry, wrong number.
Step 2.Look read and complete of part C
1. Show the picture and describe the dialogue
2. Make a dialogue in pairs
3. Check out
4. Play a game: Make friends
The way:做两组卡片:一组是课程名称,另一组是代表该课程的图片。
请几位学生各抽一张,并找出与自己卡片上的名称/图片相符的图片/
名称,引导学生复习课程名称,如一位学生出示代表PE的科目图片,
另一位学生则说PE。
5. Show the picture of part C2
6. Make a dialogue in pairs
7. Check out
Step nsolidation
1. Assign homework: finish part C
2. Recite it
课题: Unit 5 Review and check
课时: 本单元共3课时 本课为第3课时
教学目标
1. 通过复习,能熟练地掌握1-4单元所学的单词。
2. 能教熟练地在情景中运用1-4单元所学的句型和日常交际用语。
二. 教学重点
1. 能熟练地掌握1-4单元所学单词
2. 能综合运用1-4单元所学的句型和日常交际用语。
3. 能初步改编或扩充1-4单元所学的对话。
三. 教学难点
培养学生综合运用语言的能力。
四. 教学准备
挂图,图片
五.教学过程:
Step1. Revision
1. Greetings
2. Warming-up
3. Free talk
1) Do you have any hobbies?
2) What do you like?
I like…
3) What do you usually do?
4) What does he/she usually do?
He/she usually…
Step 2.Look and talk
1. Game “Do and Guess”
The way: 根据动作猜词组 给名词快速说词组
2. Show the picture of part D
1) 指导学生观察图片。
2)
3. According the model to make a new dialogue
4. Check out
Step nsolidation
Assign homework: Make a new dialogue and write it down.
5B. Unit 6 A部分 Read and Say
二、教学目标:
1. 四会掌握人体部位:arm , hand, foot , leg.
2. 熟练运用日常交际用语:Touch…with…
三、教学重、难点:
1. 熟练运用交际用语。
2. 灵活熟练运用日常交际用语。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备录音机和本课会话的磁带。
2. 准备本课会话的投影片。
3. 课前写好本课的课题5B. Unit 6 A部分 Read and Say
五、教学过程:
A Organization组织教学
1. Greetings
T: Good morning, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning, Miss Zhang.
2. Let’s sing a song 学生听录音跟唱英语歌曲What are you doing?
B Revision复习
1. Let’s speak English
T: What’s your name? Ss: My name is…
T: What are you doing? Ss: I’m reading…
T: Are you playing basketball? Ss: Yes, I am.
T: Does he play well? Ss: Yes, he does.
T: Does Mr. Black like making model ships? Ss: Yes, he does.
T: Does Mrs. Brown like cooking? Ss: Yes, she does.
2. Let’s act.
(1)T:创设情境,学生表演(T示范一组,运用祈使句)
T: Stand up. Jump, please… Touch your nose…
(2)学生模仿做。
C Presentation.新授
1. T又发命令作动作→人体部位名称。
2. T投影图片,由旧引新(T注音标,请学生试拼读)
3. arm, hand, leg, foot
4. 学生集体升降调朗读。
5. T指投影:T: Touch your nose with your hand.
学生理解后,T板书。
6. 学生集体朗读。
D Practice练习
1. T指投影图片,请同学快速说出人体部位。
2. 男女竞赛,争说人体部位。
3. 在熟练具体部位名称后,运用句型练习。
4. T发命令,学生作动作,练习数组。
T: Touch your foot with your hands.
5. 学生模仿教师,互相发命令。
6. Talk in pairs. 同桌发命令。
E Consolidations:
1. 请学生个别发命令,作动作。
2. T投影图片,请同学看图,填空,写出相应的单词。
3. 听录音,跟读B部分。
4. 总结:
(1) 要求同学们熟练运用日常交际用语:Touch…with…
(2)四会掌握人体部位。
六、布置作业:
1. 抄写四会单词各一行。
2. 跟读本课会话录音二十分钟。
七、板书设计:
Unit 6
arm hand leg foot
Touch…with…
The Second Period (第二课时)
一.教学内容:
5B.Unit 6 B 部分 Look, read and learn.
1. 四会单词:
time, left, right, stop, touch.
2. 四会句型:
Put…on…
Touch…with…
All right.
3. 日常交际用语:
Stand in a line.
Let’s do some exercises.
Now, listen carefully.
Jump up and down.
Do this…times…
Now, stand up, everybody!
二、教学目标:
1. 正确掌握四会单词。
2. 能正确掌握四会句型。
3. 熟练运用日常交际用语。
三、教学重、难点:
1. 正确掌握四会单词、句型。
2. 熟练运用日常交际用语。
3. 综合灵活熟练运用日常交际用语。
四. 课前准备:
1.准备录音机和本课会话的磁带。
2.准备人体各个部位的图片,准备贴在黑板上。
3.准备人体各个部位的单词卡片。
4.准备人体部位的投影片。
5.课前写好本课的课题5B.Unit 6 B 部分 Look, read and learn.
五、教学过程:
A Organization 组织教学
1.Greetings
T: Good morning/afternoon, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning/afternoon, Miss Zhang.
2.Let’s sing a song.学生听录音跟读唱英语歌曲 We can dance!
B Revision 复习
1. Let’s speak English.
T: Who’s on duty today? Ss: am.
T: Is everyone here today? Ss: Yes, we are all here.
T: What do you like? Ss: I like…
T: Do you like bananas? Ss: Yes I do.
T: What day is it today? Ss: It’s…
T: What lessons do you have in the morning? Ss: We have…
T: What subject do you like? Ss: I like…
2.Let’s act:请两组同学站起来表演
(1)T:创设情境,学生表演(T示范一组,运用祈使句)
T: Put…on…, please… Touch your eyes…
(2)学生模仿做。
C Presentation 新授
1. T投影图片:at a PE lesson 创建情境,让学生理解 ,在一节体育课上。
T板书,学生集体朗读。
2. T创设两个情境:让学生理解。
(1)Stand in a line , please.
Put your feet together.
Jump up and down ten times.
(2)Put your hands on your head and turn left and right.
Do this ten times
D Practice 练习
1.T板书以上情境句型→四会单词 T注音,学生集体朗读。
2.学生集体朗读四会句型。
3.T发命令学生作动作。
4.Talk in pairs. 同桌互相发命令。
5.同桌互相发命令。
E Consolidations
1.男女生互相发命令
2.看投影,学生模仿录音跟读前两段
3.总结:
(1)要求四会掌握的单词:arm ,hand ,foot, leg.
(2)要求四会掌握的句型:Put…on…
Touch…with…
All right.
六、布置作业:
1.抄写句型、单词各三遍。
2.跟读本课B部分录音二十分钟。
七、板书设计:
Unit 6
time left right stop touch
Put…on… Touch…with…. All right.
5B.Unit 6 C 部分Work in pairs.
1. 四会单词:
time, left, right, stop, touch.
2. 四会句型:
Put…on…
Touch…with…
All right.
3. 日常交际用语:
Stand in a line.
Let’s do some exercises.
Now, listen carefully.
Jump up and down.
Do this…times…
Now, stand up, everybody!
二、教学目标:
掌握句型: Touch…with… All right.
三、教学重、难点:
1. 熟练运用日常交际用语。
2. 综合熟练运用日常交际用语。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备录音机和本课的磁带。
2. 准备C部分的投影片。
3. 准备本课的单词卡片。
4. 课前写好本课的课题5B.Unit6 C部分Work in pairs.
五、教学过程:
A Organizations.组织教学
1. Greetings
T: Good morning/afternoon, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning/afternoon ,Miss Zhang.
2.Let’s sing a song.学生听录音跟读唱英语歌曲 We can dance!
B Revisions复习
1. Let’s speak English.
T: Who’s on duty today? Ss: I am.
T: Is everyone here today? Ss :Yes ,we are all here.
T: What do you like? Ss I like…
T: Do you like bananas? Ss: Yes, I do.
T: What day is it today? Ss: It’s…
T: What lessons do you have in the morning?
Ss: We have…
T: What subject do you like? Ss: I like…
2. Let’s act:请两组同学站起来表演
(1)T:创设情境,学生表演(T示范一组,运用祈使句)
T: Put…on…, please… Touch your eyes…
(2)学生模仿做。
C Presentation新授
1. 投影图片:at a PE lesson T发命令,请同学作动作。
2. 再投影另外两个情境的图片。
(1)Lie on your back. Put your knees together.
Bend your knees. Move your legs to the left, then move to the right.
(2)lift up your left leg and touch it with your right hand.
2.学生理解后,集体朗读后。
D Practice 练习
1. 发命令学生作动作,理解明白后集体朗读。
2. 个别领读。
3. Talk in pairs.
4. 学生发命令作动作。
E Consolidation
1. T投影后,整节PE课,让学生试听录音。
2. 看图片,请学生跟读录音。
3. 请学生分片段表演。
4. 总结:要求学生熟练运用日常交际用语。
六、布置作业:
1. 听录音跟读二十分钟。
2. 抄写C部分的句型两遍(两英两中)。
七、板书设计:
Unit 6
Touch…with…
All right.
The Fourth Period(第四课时)
一、教学内容:
5B.Unit 6 D 部分Look ,read and complete.
1. 掌握四会词汇:Touch…with…
2. 学习人体部分名称。
二、教学目标:
1. 正确掌握人体部位名称。
2. 熟练运用四会句型。
三、教学重、难点:
1. 正确掌握四会单词、句型。
2. 熟练运用日常交际用语。
3. 综合灵活熟练运用日常交际用语。
4. 熟练运用四会句型。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备录音机和本课的磁带。
2. 准备D部分的投影片。
3. 准备本课的单词卡片。
4. 课前写好本课的课题5B.Unit6D部分Look, read and complete.
五、教学过程
A Organization组织教学
1. Greetings
T: Good morning/afternoon, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning/afternoon, Miss Zhang.
2.Let’s sing a song.学生听录音跟读唱英语歌曲 Two jackets.
B Revision 复习
1.Let’s speak English.
T: Who’s on duty today? Ss: I am.
T: Is everyone here today? Ss: Yes, we are all here.
T: What do you like? Ss: I like…
T: Do you like bananas? Ss: Yes, I do.
T: What day is it today? Ss: It’s…
T: What lessons do you have in the morning? Ss: We have…
T: What subject do you like? Ss: I like…
2.T投影人体图片,请学生说出部分名称
3.请学生听写四会单词
4.T创设PE课的情景,请学生分片段表演
C Practice练习
1 . 由表演→句型操练Touch…with… three times
T板书,学生集体朗读
2.投影C部分图片,学生模仿说句子
3.Talk in pairs.
4.看图写句子
E Consolidation
1. Play games Chinese Whisper
传句子:Touch your head with your hand.
2.同学之间发命令作动作。
3. 总结:要求同学门熟练运用四会句型,以及日常交际用语。
六布置作业:
1.看图写句子。
2.听二十分录音并跟读。
七、板书设计:
Unit 6 At a PE lesson
Touch…with…three time
The fifth period(第五课时)
一、教学内容:
5B.Unit 6 E,F,G,H 部分.
1. 复习人体部位名称,以及体育课上的动作词组, D.E部分
2. 复习祈使句
3. 复习现在进行时
二、教学目标:
1. 正确掌握单词,词组
2. 熟练运用祈使句
3. 综合灵活运现在进行时
三、教学重、难点:
1. 正确掌握祈使句和现在进行时。
2. 祈使句语现在进行时再正确情况下使用
四、课前准备:
1. 准备录音机和本课唱歌的磁带。
2. 准备E,F,G,H的图片。
3. 课前写好本课的课题5B.Unit6.E,F,G,H部分。
五、教学过程:
A Organizations.组织教学
1. Greetings
T: Good morning/afternoon, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning/afternoon, Miss Zhang.
2. Let’s sing a song.学生听录音跟读唱英语歌曲 Two jackets.
B Revision复习
1. Let’s speak English.
T: Who’s on duty today? Ss: I am.
T: What day is it today? Ss: It’s Monday.
T: What subject do you like? Ss: I like…
T: What class are you in? Ss: I’m in Class Two.
T: What lessons do you have on Monday? Ss: We have…
2. T投影人体图片,请学生快速说出人体部位名称
3.请同学板演默写人体部位名称单词
4.T投影PE课,请同学看情景说句子。
C Practice练习
1. 请同学看情景,表演PE课内容
2. T发命令请学生作动作
3. T投影图片:D部分图片,让学生说句子作动作
4.请另外一学生运用现在进行时说出他们所做的动作
5.反复练习D部分,四幅图
6.请学生笔头完成
7.T投影E部分,请同学看图朗读;分讨论表演
六、布置作业:
1. 听录音跟读本课所内容,要求学生能够根据本课所学句子和日常交际用语进行自编会话,同桌表演。
七、板书设计:
Unit 6 At a PE lesson
D部分句型
The Sixth Period(第六课时)
一、教学内容:
第六课时是综合练习课,完成本单元学习手册。
1. F部分,活动内容。
2. 语音。
3. Sing a song.(Do some exercise with me)
二、教学目标:
1. 能听懂人体部位名称并画出。
2. 能正确听读、辨认语音。
3. 学英歌曲。
三、教学重、难点:
1.正确掌握字母组合ai、ay在单词中的发音,即[ei]
2. Listen and draw.能听懂并画出。
3 学合唱英语歌曲。
四、课前准备:
1.准备本词汇的图片。
2.准备录音机和练习册听力部分的录音。
3.黑板上预先写好课题Unit2 A telephone call.
五、教学过程:
A Say a rhyme 学生集体说歌谣,并自己配上动作。
B Free talk 师生交流。
C Revision复习
1. Let’s speak English.
T: Who’s on duty today? Ss :I am.
T: What day is it today? Ss: It’s Monday.
T: How do you feel now? Ss: I feel…
T: What’s wrong with you? Ss: I have got a fever.
2. Let’s act.
T投影PE课情景,请同学表演。
D Listen and repeat.
(1)T投影,语音. 请学生认真听然后跟读。
(2)学生集体朗读。
(3)请个别学生朗读。
E 1.T投影人体部位,请学生认人体部位名称词。
2. Listen and draw
请学生静听然后画画。
3.同桌之间互相Listen and draw
F 学唱英语歌曲。
1.先静听录音两遍,跟唱。
2.学生表演唱。
3. 总结:要求学生能听懂教师所发的命令,并能做动作。
六、布置作业:
1. 跟读录音20分钟。
2. 全面复习本单元的四会内容。
七、板书设计
Unit 6 At a PE lesson
waiter waitress day play
八、教后笔记:
通过直观教具,生动形象的动作对学生进行句型的教学,教学效果很好。人体部位名称的学习采用实物教学,学生很有兴趣。祈使句的学习采用游戏的形式对学生进行教学,让学生在玩中学到知识,由初步的感性认识再逐步上升到理性认识,最后落实到笔头,课堂教学效果很好。
Unit 7 The First Period(第一课时)
一、教学内容:
5B Unit7A部分 Read and Say
二、教学目标:
1. 能正确理解、掌握A部分会话,并能朗读、初步表演对话。
2. 能正确地运用对话中出现的日常交际用语。
3. 初步掌握会话中出现的四会单词night, half, past, a face, ready, on duty, quick, a game, a quarter, really
三、教学重、难点:
能正确理解、掌握A部分会话。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备录音机和磁带。
2. 准备投影片(早上、中午和晚上三个场景)。
3. 准备本课会话中出现的有关词汇的图片。
4. 课前在黑板上写好课题。
五、教学过程:
A Sing a song. 跟录音机边听边表演唱英文歌曲Do some exercise with me
B Free talk. 师生交流
T: Good morning, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning.
T: Glad to see you.
Ss: Glad to see you, too.
T: Let’s play a game, OK?
Ss: OK!
C Revision.复习
1. 组织学生做“听词组、做动作”和“做动作、说词组”游戏,复习动词词组get up, have breakfast, watch TV, do homework等。
2. 在熟练掌握这些动词词组后,教师演示wash my face和brush my teeth这两个词组,让学生学习。
D Presentation and drill新授和操练
1. 教师利用教具钟以What’s the time? It’s….句型引导学生学习含有past和to的表示时间的词组。
T: (教师事先将钟拨到6:30) What’s the time?
S1: It’s six thirty.
T: Yes, it’s half past six. (教师将钟拨到6:50)What’s the time?
S2: It’s six fifty.
T: Yes, it’s ten to seven. (将钟拨到6:45) What’s the time?
S3.: It’s six forty-five.
T: Yes, it’s a quarter to seven.
2. 在学生已掌握时间表达法的基础上,教师将教具钟拨到相应的点钟并说It’s half past six. It’s time to get up.再将钟拨到6:45,问学生What time is it?引导学生回答It’s a quarter to seven.后,教师说Yes, it’s time for breakfast. Let’s have breakfast.引出What time is it? It’s time for….句型。教师示范发音,学生静听、模仿、跟读。
3. 借助挂图,解释情境,教师说It’s Thursday today. David has a lot of things to do. He’s busy. He has no rest.边摆手边装着休息状,引出单词rest。
4. 出示本部分三个场景的挂图,逐步呈现对话,让学生看图听录音,整体了解会话内容。引出、学习本部分单词、词组以及相关句型。
5. 听录音,学生模仿、跟读会话。
E Practice and consolidation练习和巩固
1. 学生小组内分角色朗读会话。
2. 学生小组汇报朗读会话。
3. 小组推荐组员到台前用所学语言描述图片内容。
4. 学生小组内看图说话。
六、布置作业:
听录音跟读本课会话,小组进行会话,准备下节课表演会话。
The Second Period(第二课时)
一、教学内容:
5B. Unit 7 B部分 Look, read and learn
二、教学目标:
一、进一步掌握句型What time is it? It’s….
一、能正确地掌握含有past和to的时间表达法。
三、教学重、难点:
能正确地掌握含有past和to的时间表达法。
四、课前准备:
1、准备画有各种不同时间钟面的投影片
2、请各小组带一个钟。
3、在黑板上预先写好课题Unit7 After school。
五、教学过程:
A Listen to a rhyme 听本课的歌谣两遍,边听边用手打节奏。
B Free talk 师生交流
C Revision 复习
1. 出示A部分会话投影片,看图进行师生会话。
2. 学生看图进行小组会话。
一、学生小组会话表演。
一、Play a game : Bingo!来复习数词。
D Presentation and drill 新授和操练
1. 出示一教具钟,教师口述What time is it? It’s….分别引出含有past和to的表示时间的词组。
2. 引导学生观察含有past和to的表示时间的词组,体会、发现past和to的用法。
3. 学生小组内练说含有past和to的表示时间的词组,使学生尽快掌握此类时间表达法。
4. 出示几点一/三刻的钟面,师生问答What time is it? It’s a quarter past/to… .引出单词quarter,强调单词中字母组合ar的发音,教师示范发音,学生静听、模仿、跟读、拼读。
5. 游戏活动:听听、指指。
教师拿出事先准备好画有各种不同时间钟面的投影片,如6:30,6:35,
6:05,教师发令,学生听音并指出正确图片。待学生比较熟练后,再请一些小助手到台前发令。
E Practice and consolidation练习和巩固
1. 游戏:抢答比赛。
以每个小组为单位进行操练,任意一成员拨一时间问What time is it?其余学生拍手进行抢答(拍手最快的学生赢得抢答权)。
2. 学生听B部分录音,跟读单词。
3. 游戏活动:听听、画画、写写。
教师口述时间,学生把它们画出来,并写出该时间。比一比,看谁画得又快又准。
六、布置作业:
1、朗读并抄写本课四会单词各一行,每行抄写单词四遍。
2、课后认认钟,用英语向家长、同学汇报时间。
The Third Period(第三课时)
一、教学内容:
5B. Unit7 C部分 Ask and answer
二、教学目标:
1. 复习本单元所学词汇。
2. 进一步掌握句型What time is it? It’s….
3. 掌握句型It’s time for….。
三、教学重、难点:
四会掌握句型What time is it? It’s…. It’s time for….。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备C部分出现的图片。
2. 在黑板上预先写好课题Unit 7 After school。
五、教学过程:
A Listen to a rhyme 听本课的歌谣
B Free talk 师生交流
What time is it?
It’s….
C Revision 复习
1. 出示A部分会话投影片,看图进行学生会话。
2. 投影出示部分时间,让学生看图快速认读。
3. 看图学生分层次拼读本课四会单词。
4. 听写本单元部分四会单词、句型。
D Presentation and drill新授和操练
1. 运用教具钟拨不同的时间组织师生连锁问答。
T : What time is it?
S1.: It’s ten past one.
S1.: What time is it?
S2.: It’s twenty past five.
S2.: What time is it?
S3.: It’s a quarter to nine.
…
2. 教师出示C部分图片,继续组织师生问答,在学生回答What time is it? It’s….后,教师引导学生根据画面内容用It’s time for….的句型继续学说句子。教师与一个学生完整地示范第一幅图,并板书句型,后让学生模仿,分小组练说。
3. 小组学生汇报练习情况。教师抽查三到四组。
E Practice and consolidation练习和巩固
1. 分小组分别由学生自己挑选其他三幅图的内容,自由练说。
2. 各小组汇报练说结果。
3. 分小组朗读各图内容。
4. 学生摹仿、书写句型。
5. 游戏活动:“眼尖嘴快”
请全班学生闭上眼睛,让一名学生到台前拨时间,后该学生提问,全班学生回答,看谁答的又快又准确。
六、布置作业:
看图模仿教师板书内容造句。
七、板书设计:
Unit 7 After school
What time is it?
It’s…
It’s time for….
Unit7 D部分 Look and say
二、教学目标:
1. 复习本单元所学词汇。
2. 复习现在进行时句型。
3. 听懂、会说、会读并理解句型I want to….Do you want to join me?
三、教学重、难点:
四会掌握句型I want to….Do you want to join me?
四、课前准备:
1. 准备D部分出现的图片。
2. 在黑板上预先写好课题Unit 7 After school
五、教学过程:
A Listen to a rhyme and learn to say it.听本课的歌谣并学习歌谣 A clock。
B Free talk 师生交流
C Revision 复习
1. 出示B部分词汇图片,教师快速展示图片,学生认读并拼 读本课四会单词。
2. 出示A部分会话投影片,看图学生进行会话。
3. 投影出示不同的时间,运用句型What time is it? It’s….It’s time for….
组织师生问答。
4. 游戏活动:听听、画画、写写。
教师口述时间,学生把它们画出来,并写出该时间。比一比,看谁画得又快又准。
D Presentation and drill新授和操练
1. 教师口述示范句型I want to play cards. .Do you want to join me?让学生理解后,模仿练说。
2. 学生小组内模仿造句。
3. 小组汇报各组所造的句子。
4. 教师出示D部分图一,与一个学生示范图中会话内容:
S: I want to play cards. Do you want to join me?
T: No, I’m doing my homework.
5. 教师重复No, I’m doing my homework.通过表情、手势让学生明白该句的意思,后让学生模仿、练说。
6. 根据图片内容进行师生会话。
E Practice and consolidation练习和巩固
1. 学生分小组任意选择D部分图片内容,自编会话,进行表演。
2. 学生分小组进行汇报表演会话。
六、布置作业:
根据D部分图片内容分小组自编会话。
七、板书设计:
Unit7 After school
I want to….
Do you want to…?
No, I’m doing….
The Fifth Period(第五课时)
一、教学内容:
5B. Unit 7 E部分 Look and read, F部分Look and guess, G部分Listen and repeat
二、教学目标:
1. 通过复习,能较熟练地掌握本单元所学的词汇。
2. 能较熟练地在情景中运用本单元所学的日常交际用语和句型。
3. 听懂、会说、会读并理解E部分 Look and read。
4. 了解元音字母组合ar在单词中的读音。
5. 能熟练诵读本单元出现歌谣。
三、教学重、难点:
能正确地运用句型What time is it? It’s….It’s time for…. I want to….Do you want to…?并能在具体情景中以口、笔头形式进行交流。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备E、G部分出现的投影片。
2. 准备car, park, party, star单词卡片。
3. 在黑板上预先写好课题Unit7 After school
五、教学过程:
A Learn to say a rhyme学习歌谣 Do you like my house?
先让学生听一遍,后教师逐句领读,学生跟读。
B Free talk 师生交流
C Revision 复习
1. 出示B部分词汇图片,教师快速展示图片,学生认读并拼 读本课四会单词。
2. 出示A部分会话投影片,看图让学生用所学的语言知识来描述。
3. 引导学生用所学句型自编一段对话,是学生能灵活运用所学语言。
D Look and read
1. 教师出示E部分Look and read图片, 指导学生看图。
2. 教师边指导学生看图边组织师生问答What time is it? It’s a quarter to seven/eight/half past eight/twenty to twelve/ten to six/nine。
3. 看图,指导学生用所学句型描述各图。
F Look and guess
1. 游戏活动:你做我做。
请任一学生说时间,另一个学生根据时间做相应的动作,台下的学生用一般现在时第三人称单数句式完整地描述出学生所做的动作,如He washes his face at ten past six.
2. 学生根据本部分插图中的示范在小组内开展游戏活动。把学生分为三人一组,其中一个学生挂着一个设有时针的钟面,用左右手分别表示时针和分针。另一个学生做动作,让其他学生猜他们所演示的时间和动作,如She rides a bike at ten to three.
G Listen and repeat.
1. 教师出示单词卡片car, park, party, star,让学生认读。
2. 教师示范朗读单词,让学生跟读,后让学生体会单词中的共同音素。
3. 学生听录音跟读单词和句子,教师通过表情、手势让学生体会该句的意思。
六、布置作业:
听录音跟读本课所学内容,要求学生能够根据本课所学句子和日常交际用语进行自编会话,同桌表演。
The Sixth Period(第六课时)
一、教学内容:
5B. Unit7综合练习,本课练习册
二、教学目标:
1. 通过复习,能较熟练地掌握本单元所学的词汇和句型。
2. 能较熟练地在情景中运用本单元所学的日常交际用语并能运用所学句型进行交际。
3. 能熟练完成本课的练习册。
三、教学重、难点:
1. 熟练地掌握本单元所学词汇。
2. 能综合运用本单元所学过的句型和日常交际用语。
3. 能初步改编或扩充本单元所学的对话。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备本课词汇的图片。
2. 准备录音机和练习册听力部分的录音。
3. 黑板上预先写好课题Unit 7 After school
五、教学过程:
A Say a rhyme 学生集体说歌谣,并自己配上动作。
B Free talk 师生交流
C Revision 复习
1. 出示A部分会话投影片,看图让学生自由交际。
2. 引导学生根据自己每天的生活情况用所学句型适当扩充进行一段对话,要求学生能灵活运用所学语言。
3. 出示B部分词汇图片,教师快速展示图片,学生个别认读并拼读本课四会单词。
4. 听写本课四会单词night, half, past, a face, ready, on duty, quick, a game, a quarter, really。
D Practice 练习
1. 听听、画画、写写。让学生先听录音,然后画出时针以表示录音中提及的时间。
2. 听听、画画、搭配。先让学生根据录音内容在空白的钟面上画正确的时间,然后将表示时间的图片与表示活动的图片配对。请一位学生在投影片上示范做,然后校对。
3. 看看、想想、写写。先请学生看图,理解其意思,然后阅读句子,最后将次序乱了的字母拼成合适的词并填入空格,以使句子完整。
4. 看看、搭配、写写。让学生先看图及句子,并根据图意和句意将图旁的字母编号写在相应句子前的格子内,然后将句子和适当的时间用线连起来,最后根据图意完成句子。让学生进行小组讨论,后各组派代表板书,完成句子,看哪组做的又快又好。
5. 读读写写。学生边看图,边读句子,然后给句子进行正确排序,组成对话。先小组讨论,后小组汇报讨论结果。
6. 看看、读读、填空。让学生试着独立完成该题。
六、布置作业:
复习本单元的词汇和交际用语。
七、板书设计:
Unit7 After school
(投影)
八、教后笔记:
本单元主要围绕David一日的起居活动学习时间表达法及问答时间的句型,教师充分利用图片、努力创设情景引导学生操练。在操练过程中,学生对时间表达法有了很好的了解,并能熟练地掌握。只有个别学生对含有past, to 的时间表达法掌握还不够牢固。
5B .Unit 8 A部分 Read and Say
二、教学目标:
1 能正确理解、掌握A部分会话,并能朗读、初步表演对话。
2 能正确地运用对话中出现的日常交际用语。
3 初步掌握会话中出现的四会单词和句型。
三、教学重、难点:
能正确理解、掌握A部分会话。
四、课前准备:
1 准备本课会话的投影片。
2 准备录音机和磁带。
3 黑板上预先写好课题 Unit 8 At the weekends
五、教学过程:
A Listen to a song 听歌曲 We know.
B Free talk 师生交流
C Revision 复习
1 出示图片,让学生看图复习以前所学的词汇---go swimming/ climbing/ jogging, play football/ basketball, play the piano/ violin, go to the park/ cinema, watch TV, play chess ...
2 活动:听听、说说、做做。学生听教师口令边说、边做动作,巩固以前所学的词汇。
D Presentation and drill 新授和操练
1 教师出示一个挂历,指着星期六和星期天问学生 What do you do on Saturdays and Sundays? 学生回答 I play football. 教师接着说:How do you spend your weekends? Oh, you often play football at the weekends.让学生理解句子的意思,然后教师指着星期六和星期天对学生说 weekend, at the weekends, 让学生理解该词的含义,跟读模仿单词weekend, at the weekends 及句型How do you spend your weekends? 板书单词及句型weekend 及句型How do you spend your weekends?
2 教师在挂历的大部分周末处画上足球,剩下的画上TV---T : How do you spend your weekends? 启发学生回答: I often play football. Sometimes I watch TV. 通过直观的图示使学生了解often 和sometimes 的含义,板书单词often 和sometimes 及句型I often play football. Sometimes I watch TV.
3 师生问答,学习并操练How do you spend your weekends?及其答语 I often ... Sometimes I ...
4 教师出示课文投影片简介课文内容,让学生了解对话的背景,然后问学生:Look. This is Wang Bing. How does he spend his weekends? He likes surfing the Internet.通过画有电脑的投影片使学生明白该句的意思。教师接着说:I likes surfing the Internet, too. I think it's very interesting. I can learn a lot from it. I can read novels、learn English、QQ, etc on the Internet. What do you think of it? 教师通过手势、表情引出单词very, learn from, 教师示范发音,学生静听、模仿、跟读,并拼读。
5 教师接着介绍课文中人物的周末活动,然后问:How does he/she spend his/ her weekends? 通过手势、表情让学生理解该句的意思,引导学生用He/ She often ... 和 Sometimes he/ she... 回答,板书学习单词sport, catch, of course
6 让学生分层次练说句型How does he/she spend his/ her weekends? He/ She often ... 和 Sometimes he/ she...
7 让学生看图、听录音,整体理解对话。
E Practice and consolidation练习和巩固
1 让学生听录音,模仿跟读。
2 学生小组分角色朗读。
3 在熟读的基础上让学生在小组内试着表演对话。
4 游戏活动:看看、说说。让一个学生做动作,其他学生用英语描述。
六 布置作业:
听本课对话的录音,要求学生跟读、读熟,并能够在小组内进行表演。
The Second Period(第二课时)
一、教学内容:
5B. Unit 8 B部分 Look, read and learn
二、教学目标:
1 通过复习能正确熟练掌握A部分会话,并能表演对话。
2 能正确地?
yjs21.cOm更多幼儿园教案编辑推荐
八年级上册英语课件范本6篇
老师会对课本中的主要教学内容整理到教案课件中,所以老师写教案可不能随便对待。教案是评估学生学习效果的有效依据,好的教案课件是怎么写成的?我们听了一场关于“八年级上册英语课件”的演讲让我们思考了很多,经过阅读本页你的认识会更加全面!
八年级上册英语课件 篇1
一、教学目标:
1.语言知识目标:
1)学习掌握下列词汇:copy, return
2)进行一步复习巩固学习Section A部分所学的生词和词组。
3)对询问困难及提出的建议的句型,掌握其规则。
4)通过不同方式的练习,来熟练运用询问及提建议的表达方式。
2.情感态度价值观目标:
让学生了解每个人在生活中都有可能遇到一些挫折和不幸,我们多去向那些不幸和困难的人们多表示自己的爱心,多去理解和帮助他们,多向他们提出解决问题的建议而不是去嘲笑他们。
二、教学重难点言
1.教学重点:
1)复习巩固Section A部分所学的生词和词组,达到熟练运用的目标。
2)熟练掌握和运用询问困难和提建议的表达方式。
2.教学难点:
1) 总结询问问题和提出建议的句型,掌握规则。
2)练习运用所学的句型。
三、教学过程
Step 1 Warming- up and revision
1. Have a dictation of the new words learned in the last class.
make sth. clear (同义词) ___________
talk (同义词) _______________
not allow (同义词) ______________
worried (同义词) ______________
get along with (同义词) ____________
communicate (名词)_____________
old (比较级) _______________
2. Check the homework.
3. Let some Ss read the article in 3a. Then finish the short passage about Sad and Thirteen. (见课件)
1. Sad and Thirteen has some _________. He can’t __________his family. His parents _____ a lot. It’s the only _____________ they have. When they _____, it’s like a big black cloud ____________their home. He doesn’t like it.
His brother always watches whatever he wants until midnight. He _______ to let him watch his favorite TV show. So He always feels ______ and ________ at home.
2. Robert Hunt thinks Sad and Thirteen should _________ these feelings to his family. He should ____ to help. Maybe he _________ _____ jobs around the house so that they have more time _______________________. Second, he could sit down and ____________ ____ his brother. He could ________ that he _________ him watching TV all the time, however, he should let him watch his _____________.
八年级上册英语课件 篇2
Section A1
一、教学目标:
1. 语言知识目标:
1) 能掌握以下单词:grow up, computer programmer, cook, doctor, engineer, violinist, driver, pilot, pianist, scientist, be sure about, make sure
能掌握以下句型:
① ─What do you want to be when you grow up?
─I want to be a basketball player.
② ─How are you going to do that?
─I’m going to practice basketball every day.
③ Where are you going to work?
④ When are you going to start?
⑤ I’m not sure about that.
2) 能了解以下语法:
掌握一般将来时态的构成形式;
3) 用一般将来时态表达将要做的事情。
2. 情感态度价值观目标:
每个人都有自己的梦想和对未来的打算,对于将来想要从事的职业也充满了憧憬。 人们以常谈论他们的设想,因此,应通过学习这单元的内容来激发学生们的学习主动性和学习兴趣,使他们更加有理想,并为实现自己的理想而不断努力。
二、教学重难点
1. 教学重点:
1) 学习一般将来时态的构成方式。
2) 学习本课时出现的重点句型,通过在不同情景下运用来熟练运用一般将来时态。
2. 教学难点:
用一般将来时态表达自己未来的打算。
三、教学过程
Ⅰ. Lead-in
1. 介绍自己小时候想要从事的职业,由此归纳出以前所学过的一些职业的英语表达方式:
teacher, nurse, doctor, basketball player, runner, actor, actress…
2. 询问学生们想要从事的职业,从而引出句型:
─ What do you want to be when you grow up?
─ I want to be a basketball player.
3. 学生们看幻灯片,引导学生们进行问答自己将来所喜欢的职业。
Ⅱ. Presentation
1. 播放幻灯片,展示一些职业的图片,来引导学生们学习一些新的职业名词:
computer programmer, cook, engineer, violinist, pianist, pilot, scientist,…
2. 让学生们看大屏幕来学习记忆这些生词。
3. Tell Ss to rank them [1-12]. 1 is most interesting, 12 is least interesting.
2. Try to remember the new words.
Ⅲ. Game
1. Show some pictures in the big screen.
2. Let Ss guess what he/she does.
3. Let Ss try their best to guess the job. See which group is the best.
Ⅳ. Listening
1. T: Tell Ss to read the words of jobs in the chart. Make sure they know the meaning of the words and sentences.
2. Play the recording for the Ss to listen and fill in the blanks.
3. Play the recording again. Check the answers with the Ss.
4. Play the recording again. Ss listen and match the jobs with activities.
5. Show the answers on the big screen.
Ⅴ. Pair work
1. Let Ss read the model with a partner.
2. Use the information in the chart of 1b. Ask and answer with a partner.
3. Let some pairs ask and answer about the chart.
Ⅵ. Listening
Work on 2a:
1. Let Ss look at the pictures below. Explain the activities in the pictures if necessary.
2. Play the recording for the Ss to listen and check (√) the correct boxes in the picture.
3. Play the recording again to check the answers.
Work on 2b:
1. Let Ss read the chart below. Tell Ss that they’ll listen to Cheng Han’s plan for the future. They should answer the questions:
“What” means “What is Cheng Han want to be?”
“Where” means “where is Cheng Han going to work?”
“How” means “How is he going to do it? ”
“When” means “when is he going to start?”
2. Play the recording for the Ss to write the correct answers in the chart.
3. Play the recording again to check the answers.
Ⅶ. Pair work
1. Tell Ss to ask and answer about Cheng Han’s plans using the information in 2b.
2. Give a model to the Ss.
3. Ss work in pairs. Try to ask and answer about Cheng Han’s plans.
4. Ask some pairs to act out their conversations.
Ⅷ. Role-play
1. Read the conversations and answer the two questions:
① What does Ken want to be? __________________________________
② How is he going to do that? __________________________________
③ What does Andy want to be? ____________________________________
2. Explain main points in the conversation.
The Old Man and the Sea by Hemingway. 海明威的《老人与海》。 此处介词by为“由……所著”之意。再如:a short story by Lu Xun (鲁迅的一部短篇小说),the music by Mozart(莫扎特写的音乐),paintings by Van Gogh(梵高的绘画)等。
Then you can be anything you want! 那么你就能当上你想做的人了。
此句的基本意思是you can be anything,不定代词anything指代未来所从事的某一职业,you want用来修饰anything。
3. Let Ss read the conversation after the teacher.
4. Practice the conversation with their partner. Then let some pairs to act out the conversation.
Homework:
1. Recite the conversation in 2d after school.
2. 根据图片提示或自己的实际想法编写一个对话。
--What are you going to be when you grow up?
--I’m going to be a/an…
--How are you going to do that?
--I’m going to…
Section A2 (Grammar focus-3c)
一、教学目标:
1. 语言知识目标:
1) 学习掌握下列词汇:college, education, medicine, university, London, article, send
2)进行下一步复习巩固学习Section A 部分所学的生词和词组。
3)总结一般将来时态的句子结构,并掌握其在不同句式中的句子结构。
4) 能够熟练运用一般将来时态的句子来表达自己未来的打算和做法等情况。
2. 情感态度价值观目标:
每个人都有自己的梦想和对未来的打算,对于将来想要从事的职业也充满了憧憬。 人们以常谈论他们的设想,因此,应通过学习这单元的内容来激发学生们的学习主动性和学习兴趣,使他们更加有理想,并为实现自己的理想而不断努力。
二、教学重难点
1. 教学重点:
1) 复习巩固Section A 部分所学的生词和词组,达到熟练运用的目标。
2) 能够熟练运用一般将来时态的句子来表达自己未来的打算和做法等情况。
2. 教学难点:
1) 掌握一般将来时态的句子结构,并掌握其在不同句式中的句子结构。
2) 能够熟练运用一般将来时态的句子来表达自己未来的打算和做法等情况。
三、教学过程
Ⅰ. Warming- up and revision
1. Have a dictation of the new words learned in the last class.
2. Game: Give some riddles on jobs to the Ss. Ss try to guess the job.
3. Ask and answer what they want to be and how they’re going to do that.
4. Role-play the conversation in 2d.
Ⅱ. Grammar Focus.
1. 学生阅读Grammar Focus中的句子,然后做填空练习。
① 当你长大后,你想做什么?
What do you want ____ ___ When you _____ _____?
② 我想成为一名工程师。
I want to ______ ___ _________.
③ 你打算如何做?
How ______ you _____ to ____that?
④ 我打算努力地学习数学。
I’m _______ _____ ______ _____ really hard.
⑤ 想去哪里工作?
______ _______ you going to work?
⑥ 我打算搬往上海。
I’m ______ _____ ________ to Shanghai.
⑦你打算从什么时候开始?
When ______you _______ to _____?
⑧ 我打算完成中学和大学时开始。
I’m going to _____ _______I _____ high school and _________.
2. 学生们根据记忆,看大屏幕来完成填空练习。
3. 学生们完成填空试题后,可以打开课本检查答案,对错误的句子,单独进行强化记忆。
Ⅲ. Try to Find
一、一般将来时态:
1. 表示即将发生的事或最近 ____________ 的动作。表示说话者的______________
例句:
我打算下个月去北京参观。
I’m going to visit Beijing next year.
她打算长大后,搬往上海。
She’s going to move to Shanghai when I grow up.
练一练:
① 玛丽要卖她的汽车。
Mary is going to sell her car.
② 今天早上我将不吃早餐。
Im not going to have breakfast this morning.
③ 你打算邀请约翰参加你的聚会吗?
Are you going to invite John to your party?
④ 你打算买什么?
What are you going to buy?
want to be的用法
Ⅳ. Practice
Work on 3a:
1. Tell Ss to read the sentences in 3a and match what these people want to do with what they are going to do.
2. 方法指导:指导:先读懂这些句子的意思。根据生活常识来进行推测,将职业与相关的活动相连。
比如,在第一题中,“我朋友相成为一名工程师。” 由常识可知答语应是学习数学;因此应选e句“她打算学习数学。”其他类似。
3.学生们,按老师指导的方法进行阅读,并根据常识来推测应采取什么样的活动。
4. 最后,教师与同学们一起校对答案,并对学生们有疑问的地方进行解释。
Work on 3b:
1. 让学生们阅读对话,整体把握对话的意思。
2. 然后仔细读对话,根据上下文意及时态来确定空格处所应填的词。
3. 和学生们一起校对答案。
4. 让学生们朗读并表演这个对话。
Ⅴ. Group work
1. 让学生们看表格中的四个特殊疑问词,告诉他们,在这个活动中要求学生们在表格中填写出自己的理想、实现理想的做法,工作的地点及开始的时间等问题。
2. 学生们与自己的小组成员一起来讨论自己理想、实现理想的做法,工作的地点及开始的时间等问题,同学们根据自己的实际情况,在表格先填写出自己打算成为什么职业的人;打算在哪里工作;打算如何做;打算什么时候开始。
3. 就上述问题,根据表格的提示,用英语进行讨论。
4. 让几个小组的同学来用英语问题上述四个问题。
(最后,可以经学生们评议来推举最有能力的小组)
Ⅵ. Exercises
If time is enough, do some more exercises on big screen.
重排下列句子,成为一段完整的对话。
A. Are you going to move to Hollywood?
B. Well, I’m going to take acting lessons.
C. What are you going to be when you grow up?
D. I’m going to finish high school and college first.
E. When are you going to start?
F. I’m going to be an actor.
G. And how are you going to become an actor?
H. No, I’m going to move to New York.
___, ___, ____, ____, ___, ___, ___, ____
Homework
1. 复习Grammar focus 中的内容。
2. 用正确的形式填空。
1) We are ____________________ (play) basketball tomorrow.
2)They __________________ (visit) their aunt next week.
3)_____Lucy______________(watch)movie with Lily tomorrow? No, _____ ______.
4)There ___________________________ (be) a football match tomorrow.
5)They ___________________ (not practice guitar) next week.
板书设计
Section B1 1a-2e
一、教学目标:
1. 语言知识目标:
1) 能掌握以下单词:resolution, team, foreign, able, be able to, question, meaning, discuss, promise, beginning, write down, physical, themselves, have to do with; self-improvement, take up, hobby, weekly, schoolwork
2) 能掌握以下句式结构:
① ─What are you going to do next year?
─I’m going to take guitar lessons.
② Many resolutions have to do with self-improvement.
③ They’re going to take up a hobby like painting.
④ Sometimes the resolutions may be too difficult to keep.
2. 情感态度价值观目标:
每个人都有自己的梦想和对未来的打算,对于将来想要从事的职业也充满了憧憬。 人们以常谈论他们的设想,因此,应通过学习这单元的内容来激发学生们的学习主动性和学习兴趣,使他们更加有理想,并为实现自己的理想而不断努力。
二、教学重难点
1. 教学重点:
1) 掌握本课时出现的生词及表达方式。
2) 进行听力训练,提高综合听说能力。
3) 阅读短文,获得相关信息,提高学生们的综合阅读能力。
2. 教学难点
1. 听力训练
2. 阅读2b部分的短文并完成相关要求。
三、教学过程
Ⅰ. Warming- up and revision
1. Daily greeting. Check the homework.
2. 头脑风暴: 说出表示的职业名词
teacher, nurse, doctor, actor, actress, runner, basketball player, pilot, waiter, computer programmer, pianist, scientist, violinist…
学生们可以小组为单位进行比赛,看谁写出来的最多。(在五分钟内)
3. 说理想,谈打算。
I want to be an engineer. I’m going to study math.
让学生们依次说出他们的理想及打算如何去做。(可以用大屏幕提示职业或用学生们自己刚才写的职业)
Ⅱ. Presentation
1. T: Do you have any New Year’s Resolutions?
Let some Ss answer your questions.
2. Present some other New Year’s Resolutions on the big screen.
e.g. learn to play the piano; make the soccer team; get good grades; eat healthier food; get lots of exercise
3. Let Ss try remember these resolutions and think of other resolutions.
Ⅲ. Talking
1. Tell your partners your New Year’s Resolutions.
2. S1: I’m going to get lots of exercise. I’m going to make a basketball team.
S2: I’m going to learn another foreign language. I’m going to learn French.
S3: …
3. Let Ss say as many resolutions as they can.
Ⅳ. Listening
Work on 1c:
1. Tell Ss to read the resolutions in 1a. Tell Ss to listen and circle the resolutions they hear.
3. Play the recording for the Ss to listen and circle.
4. Check the answers:
Work on 1d:
1. T: Now please look at the chart in 1d. Tell Ss Lucy, Kim and Mike are talking about their New Year’s Resolutions. How are they going to do it? Listen and try to fill in the blanks.
听力指导:本题要求同学们听清他们打算如何做来实现他们各的理想;因此,同学们在听的时候应将注意力放在“如何做”上;第一遍仅听,努力记住要做的事情;第二遍的时候再写出来。
2. Ss listen to the recording carefully and try to fill in the blanks.
3. Play the recording again and check the answers with the class.
Ⅴ. Group work
1. Work in groups. Make a list of resolutions and how you are going to make them work. Then discuss with your group.
2. Ask some pairs to act out the conversations.
3. Ask Ss the two questions:
Did you make any resolutions last year?
Were you able to keep them? Why or why not?
Ⅵ. Reading
1. T: This passage is about resolutions. Now read the passage quickly and match each paragraph with its main purpose.
2. Let Ss read the sentences in the box first. Let some Ss say the meanings.
3. Ss read the passage quickly and match each paragraph with its main purpose.
4. Let Ss underline the words and phrases that helped them decide.
Ⅶ. Reading
1. T: Now let’s work on 2c. First, let’s read the sentences and make sure we know the meanings of all the sentences. Then read the passage again and chose which paragraph in the passage each sentence goes in.
2. 方法指导:首先,应读懂五个句子的意思;然后,带着这五个句子再次认真阅读短文的内容,特别是认真阅读空格前后句子的意思,以便根据上下文意及整个段落的意思来确定空格处应填的句子。 综合段落的主旨大意及空格上下文的意思,确定最贴切的答案。
3. Ss read carefully and try to find the answers to the questions.
4. Check the answers with the class.
Ⅷ. Reading
1. T: Read the passage again. Then answer the questions with short sentences.
2. 方法指导:首先,读懂这五个问题的意思;然后,带着问题再次阅读短文,为相关问题找到恰当的答语;如果没有直接的答案,还应根据自己对课文的理解并结合自己的生活经验来给出一个恰当的答案。如:第4和第5小题都应是回答自己的想法。
3. Ss try to answer the questions. Then discuss the answers with your partners.
Explanation
1. Some resolutions have to do with better planning, … 有些决定与合理的时间规划相关,……
1) 此句中的planning为名词,表示“计划;规划”等意思,如:city planning(城市规划)等。英语中better planning类似汉语中的“合理规划”,指通过制定计划来更加充分的利用时间、空间、精力等。
2) have to do with这个结构表示“与……相关;与……有关联或有关系”。例如:What does this problem have to do with what we’re learning today?
这道题跟我们今天所学的内容有什么关系?
2. Sometimes the resolutions may be too difficult to keep.
有时这些决定可能会太难而无法实现。
此处情态动词may表示推测,相当于汉语的“可能;或许;大概”之意。又如:You may be right this time, but I’m not sure. 这一次你或许是对的,但我无法确定。
2) 英语中too…to…是一种固定结构,表示“太……而不能够……”。又如:
The kid is too young to play this game.
这孩子太小,不能玩这个游戏。
3) 本句中的动词keep意为“履行(诺言等);遵守(惯例等)”,这是keep的常见用法之一。类似的句子还有:
People hardly ever keep them!
人们很少履行它们(指计划)。
在这一语义下,常见的表示还有keep a promise(信守诺言),keep one’s word(遵守承诺;说话算数)等。如:
We always keep our word.
我们说话是算数的。
Homework
1. 课后阅读短文,试着复述课文,总结课文出现的重难点词组及表达方式。
2. 完成2e的任务;用这些词组来造句。
板书设计:
Section B2 3a-Self check
一、教学目标:
1. 语言知识目标:
1) 复习一般将来时态的构成。掌握生词own, personal, relationship
2) 能够综合运用一般将来时态及所给的提示词来完成阅读填空的任务。
3) 能够综合运用所学的知识来学习写作自己的新年决心。
4)通过完成Self check的中练习题来全面复习一般将来时态的用法。
2. 情感态度价值观目标:
每个人都有自己的梦想和对未来的打算,对于将来想要从事的职业也充满了憧憬。 人们以常谈论他们的设想,因此,应通过学习这单元的内容来激发学生们的学习主动性和学习兴趣,使他们更加有理想,并为实现自己的理想而不断努力。
二、教学重难点
1. 教学重点:
1) 能够综合运用一般将来时态及所给的提示词来完成阅读填空的任务。
2)能够综合运用所学的知识来学习写作自己的新年决心。
2. 教学难点:
能够综合运用所学的知识来学习写作自己的新年决心。
三、教学过程
Ⅰ. Warming- up and revision
1. Have a dictation of the new words and expressions.
2. Fill in the blanks of the main idea of the passage in 2b: (On the big screen)
1. A resolution is a kind of p ________. We usually make resolutions at the b_______ of the year. We hope to i_______ our lives.
2. Some resolutions are about p_______ health. Many resolutions have to do with self-improvement. Some resolutions have to do with better planning, like making a w_______ plan for s___________.
3. Review the phrases. And make a sentence with it.
1) 在……的开端_________________
2) 写下;记录下 _________________
3) 关于;与有关系 _________________
4) 学着做;开始 做___________________
5) 有相同之处 ________________
6) 太……而不能 ________________
7) 向某人许诺 _____________
8) 提高某人的生活___________
Ⅱ. Lead-in
1. Ask Ss about their New Year’s Resolutions:
e.g.
T: What’s your New Year’s Resolutions, Mary?
Mary: I want to take up volleyball next term.
T: Great! What about you, Jack?
Jack:I’m going to make a soccer team. And we’re going to practice soccer every weekend.
…
2. Present some new words on the big screen. Explain them to the Ss. Ss try to remember them.
own, personal, relationship
Ⅲ. Reading
1. Tell Ss to work on 3b. Complete the first two paragraphs about resolutions with the words in the box.
2. 写作指导:
首先,阅读方框中的词汇,掌握其意思,然后阅读短文,整体把握短文大意。
其次,分析有空格的每个句子,根据上下文意及句子结构确定空格处应填哪一个词。
最后,将单词填在空格上,并完整的读一遍短文,看是否通顺。
3. Ss try to read the article and try to fill in the blanks.
4. Check the answers with the Ss.
Ⅳ. Writing
Work on 3b:
1. Read the headings below. Think about your own resolutions.
2. Write your own resolutions under the following heading.
(If you don’t have any ideas, you may go through the passage in 2b. )
3. Ss try to think about their own resolutions and try to write them down.
4. Check the answers with your partners.
Work on 3c:
1. Tell Ss to use the notes in 3b and write three more paragraphs about their resolutions.
In each paragraph, write what they are going to do and why.
2. 写作指导:
本文为写自己决心、及做法,并说明原因。
因此,时态应用一般将来时态;
应先根据3b的想法,说明自己的决心;然后,具体说一下自己打算怎样去实现这个理由;最后,再简单地说一些做此事的原因。
应注意一般将来时态的结构(be going to),不要丢掉be 动词am。这是同学们最易出现的错误。
3. 学生们根据写作提示,及上面表格中的提示来写作这篇文章。
4. Let some Ss read their passage to the class.
Ⅴ. Discussing
1. Discuss the environment in your city. Are the street and the park clean? Is the air clean? Is it quiet or noisy?
2. Tell Ss: It’s everyone’s duty to keep our city clean and tidy. Can you think of a plan to make it cleaner and greener?
3. Give Ss some examples:
We’re going to make the subway better. Then people don’t have to drive to work.
We’re going to plant more trees and flowers in the park and street.
…
4. Ss try to write about their own plans on a piece of paper.
5. Let some Ss read out their plans. See who has a best one.
Ⅵ. Self check
Work on Self check 1:
1. Match the jobs with the school subjects.
2. Check the answers. Then let some Ss make some sentences with them. e.g.
I want to be a computer programmer. I’m going to study computer science.
3. 指导: 复习运用句型结构:I want to be…, I’m going to …
4. 学生自主写句子,然后相互检查答案。
Work on Self check 2
1. Tell Ss to read the conversation and fill in the blanks with the right words.
2. Ss work by themselves.
3. Check the answers and explain some main points. e.g.
第三行:How; going; 分析句子结构,主、谓、宾语都有,可知应缺少状语成分;句意:你打算如何做?
3. 学生们分角色表演这个对话。
Work on Self check 3
1. Tell Ss to make their own plans using the phrases below.
2. Ss work with their partners. Write down their own plans.
3. Let some Ss read their plans. Correct any mistakes.
Homework
1. Review Section B.
2. Interview five of your friends. Ask them what they’re going to do next weekend. Then write a report.
八年级上册英语课件 篇3
1) leave的用法
1.“leave+地点”表示“离开某地”。例如:
When did you leave Shanghai?
你什么时候离开上海的?
2.“leave for+地点”表示“动身去某地”。例如:
Next Friday, Alice is leaving for London.
下周五,爱丽斯要去伦敦了。
3.“leave+地点+for+地点”表示“离开某地去某地”。例如:
Why are you leaving Shanghai for Beijing?
你为什么要离开上海去北京?
2) 情态动词should“应该”学会使用
should作为情态动词用,常常表示意外、惊奇、不能理解等,有“竟会”的意思,例如:
How should I know? 我怎么知道?
Why should you be so late today? 你今天为什么来得这么晚?
should有时表示应当做或发生的事,例如:
We should help each other.我们应当互相帮助。
我们在使用时要注意以下几点:
1. 用于表示“应该”或“不应该”的概念。此时常指长辈教导或责备晚辈。
例如:
You should be here with clean hands. 你应该把手洗干净了再来。
2. 用于提出意见劝导别人。例如:
You should go to the doctor if you feel ill.
如果你感觉不舒服,你最好去看医生。
3. 用于表示可能性。should的这一用法是考试中常常出现的考点之一。例如:
We should arrive by supper time. 我们在晚饭前就能到了。
She should be here any moment. 她随时都可能来。
3) What...? 与 Which...?
1. what 与 which 都是疑问代词,都可以指人或事物,但是what仅用来询问
职业。如:
What is your father? 你父亲是干什么的?
该句相当于:
What does your father do?
What is your father's job?
Which 指代的是特定范围内的某一个人。如:
---Which is Peter? 哪个是皮特?
---The boy behind Mary. 玛丽背后的那个男孩。
2. What...? 是泛指,所指的事物没有范围的限制;而 Which...? 是特指,
所指的事物有范围的限制。如:
What color do you like best?(所有颜色)你最喜爱什么颜色?
Which color do you like best, blue, green or yellow?
你最喜爱哪一种颜色? (有特定的范围)
3. what 与 which 后都可以接单、复数名词和不可数名词。如:
Which pictures are from China? 哪些图片来自中国?
4) 频度副词的位置
1.常见的频度副词有以下这些:
always(总是,一直)
usually(通常)
often(常常,经常)
sometimes(有时候)
never(从不)
2.频度副词的位置:
a.放在连系动词、助动词或情态动词后面。如:
David is often arrives late for school.大卫上学经常迟到。
b.放在行为动词前。如:
We usually go to school at 7:10 every day.
我们每天经常在7:10去上学。
c.有些频度副词可放在句首或句尾,用来表示强调。如:
Sometimes I walk home, sometime I ride a bike.
有时我步行回家,有时我骑自行车。
3.never放在句首时,主语、谓语动词要倒装。如:
Never have I been there.我从没到过那儿。
5) every day 与 everyday
1. every day 作状语,译为“每一天”。如:
We go to school at 7:10 every day.
我们每天7:10去上学。
I decide to read English every day.
我决定每天读英语。
2. everyday 作定语,译为“日常的”。
She watches everyday English on TV after dinner.
她晚饭后在电视上看日常英语。
What's your everyday activity? 你的日常活动是什么?
6) 什么是助动词
1.协助主要动词构成谓语动词词组的词叫助动词(Auxiliary Verb)。被协助的
动词称作主要动词(Main Verb)。助动词自身没有词义,不可单独使用,
例如:
He doesn't like English. 他不喜欢英语。
(doesn't是助动词,无词义;like是主要动词,有词义)
2.助动词协助主要动词完成以下功用,可以用来:
a. 表示时态,例如:
He is singing. 他在唱歌。
He has got married. 他已结婚。
b. 表示语态,例如:
He was sent to England. 他被派往英国。
c. 构成疑问句,例如:
Do you like college life? 你喜欢大学生活吗?
Did you study English before you came here?
你来这儿之前学过英语吗?
d. 与否定副词not合用,构成否定句,例如:
I don't like him. 我不喜欢他。
e. 加强语气,例如:
Do come to the party tomorrow evening. 明天晚上一定来参加晚会。
He did know that. 他的确知道那件事。
3.最常用的助动词有:be, have, do, shall, will, should, would
7) forget doing/to do与remember doing/to do
1.forget to do忘记要去做某事(未做);forget doing忘记做过某事(已做)
The light in the office is still on. He forgot to turn it off.
办公室的灯还在亮着,它忘记关了。(没有做关灯的动作)
He forgot turning the light off.
他忘记他已经关了灯了。 ( 已做过关灯的动作)
Don't forget to come tomorrow.
别忘了明天来。 (to come动作未做)
典型例题
---- The light in the office is still on.
---- Oh,I forgot___.
A. turning it off B. turn it off
C. to turn it off D. having turned it off
答案:C。由the light is still on 可知灯亮着,即关灯的动作没有发生,
因此用forget to do sth.而forget doing sth 表示灯已经关上了,而
自己忘记了这一事实。此处不符合题意。
2.remember to do记得去做某事(未做);
remember doing记得做过某事(已做)
Remember to go to the post office after school.
记着放学后去趟邮局。
Don't you remember seeing the man before?
你不记得以前见过那个人吗?
8) It's for sb.和 It's of sb.
1.for sb. 常用于表示事物的特征特点,表示客观形式的形容词,如:
easy, hard,difficult,interesting,impossible等:
It's very hard for him to study two languages.
对他来说学两门外语是很难的。
2.of sb的句型一般用表示人物的性格,品德,表示主观感情或态度的形容词,
如:good, kind, nice, clever, foolish, right。
It's very nice of you to help me. 你来帮助我,你真是太好了。
3.for 与of 的辨别方法:
用介词后面的代词作主语,用介词前边的形容词作表语,造个句子。如果道理上通顺用of,不通则用for。如:
You are nice. (通顺,所以应用of)。
He is hard. (人是困难的,不通,因此应用for。)
9) 对两个句子的提问
新目标英语在命题中有将对句子划线提问这一题型取消的趋势,现在采取的作
法是对一个句子进行自由提问。例如:
句子:The boy in blue has three pens.
提问:1. Who has three pens?
2. Which boy has three pens?
3. What does the boy in blue have?
4. How many pens does the boy in blue have?
很显然,学生多了更多的回答角度,也体现了考试的灵活性。再如:
句子:He usually goes to the park with his friends at 8:00 on Sunday.
提问:1. Who usually goes to the park with his friends at 8:00 on Sunday?
2. Where does he usually go with his friends at 8:00 on Sunday?
3. What does he usually do with his friends at 8:00 on Sunday?
4. With whom does he usually go to the park at 8:00 on Sunday?
5. What time does he usually go to the park with his friends on
Sunday?
6. When does he usually go to the park with his friends?
10) so、such与不定冠词的使用
1.so与不定冠词a、an连用,结构为“so+形容词+a/an+名词”。如:
He is so funny a boy.
Jim has so big a house.
2.such与不定冠词a、an连用,结构为“such+a/an+形容词+名词”。如:
It is such a nice day.
That was such an interesting story.
11) 使用-ing分词的几种情况
1.在进行时态中。如:
He is watching TV in the room.
They were dancing at nine o'clock last night.
2.在there be结构中。如:
There is a boy swimming in the river.
3.在have fun/problems结构中。如:
We have fun learning English this term.
They had problems getting to the top of the mountain.
4.在介词后面。如:
Thanks for helping me.
Are you good at playing basketball?
5.在以下结构中:
enjoy doing sth 乐于做某事
finish doing sth 完成做某事
feel like doing sth 想要做某事
stop doing sth 停止做某事
forget doing sth 忘记做过某事
go on doing sth 继续做某事
remember doing sth 记得做过某事
like doing sth 喜欢做某事
keep sb doing sth 使某人一直做某事
find sb doing sth 发现某人做某事
see/hear/watch sb doing sth
看到/听到/观看某人做某事
try doing sth 试图做某事
need doing sth 需要做某事
prefer doing sth 宁愿做某事
mind doing sth 介意做某事
miss doing sth 错过做某事practice doing sth 练习做某 be busy doing sth 忙于做某事
can't help doing sth
禁不住做某事
12) 英语中的“单数”
1.主语的第三人称单数形式,即可用“he, she, it”代替的。如:
he,she, it,my friend, his teacher, our classroom, Tom, Mary's uncle
2.名词有单数名词和复数名词。如:
man(单数)---men(复数) banana(单数)---bananas(复数)
3.动词有原形,第三人称单数形式,-ing分词,过去式,过去分词。如:
go---goes---going---went---gone
work---works---working---worked---worked
watch---watches---watching---watched---watched
当主语为第三人称单数的时候,谓语动词必须用相应的第三人称单数形式。
如:
The boy wants to be a sales assistant.
Our English teacher is from the US.
Their daughter makes her breakfast all by herself.
13) 名词的复数构成的几种形式
名词复数的构成可分为规则变化和不规则变化两种。
I 名词复数的规则变化
1.一般在名词词尾加-s。如:
pear---pears hamburger---hamburgers
desk---desks tree---trees
2.以字母-s, -sh, -ch, -x结尾的名词,词尾加-es。如:
class---classes dish---dishes
watch---watches box---boxes
3.以字母-o结尾的某些名词,词尾加-es。如:
potato---potatoes tomato---tomatoes
Negro---Negroes hero---heroes
4.以辅音字母加-y结尾的名词,将-y变为-i,再加-es。如:
family---families dictionary---dictionaries
city---cities country---countries
5.以字母-f或-fe结尾的名词,将-f或-fe变为-v,再加-es。如:
half---halves leaf---leaves
thief---thieves knife---knives
self---selves wife---wives
life---lives wolf---wolves
shelf---shelves loaf---loaves
但是:
scarf---scarves(fes) roof---roofs
serf---serfs gulf---gulfs
chief---chiefs proof---proofs
belief---beliefs
II 名词复数的不规则变化
1.将-oo改为--ee。如:
foot---feet tooth---teeth
2.将-man改为-men。如:
man---men woman---women
policeman---policemen postman---postmen
3.添加词尾。如:
child---children
4.单复数同形。如:
sheep---sheep deer---deer
fish---fish people---people
5.表示“某国人”的单、复数变化。
即“中日瑞不变英法变,其它国把-s加后面”。如:
Chinese---Chinese Japanese---Japanese Swiss---Swiss
Englishman---Englishmen Frenchman---Frenchmen
American---Americans Australian---Australians
Canadian---Canadians Korean---Koreans
Russian---Russians Indian---Indians
6.其它。如:
mouse---mice
apple tree---apple trees
man teacher---men teachers
14) 双写最后一个字母的-ing分词
初中阶段常见的有以下这些:
1.let→letting 让
hit→hitting 打、撞
cut→cutting 切、割
get→getting 取、得到
sit→sitting 坐
forget→forgetting 忘记
put→putting 放
set→setting 设置
babysit→babysitting
临时受雇照顾婴儿
→shopping 购物
trip→tripping 绊
stop→stopping 停止
drop→dropping 放弃
3.travel→travel(l)ing 旅游
swim→swimming 游泳
run→running 跑步
dig→digging 挖、掘
begin→beginning 开始
prefer→preferring 宁愿
plan→planning 计划
15) 肯定句变否定句及疑问句要变化的一些词
1.some变为any。如:
There are some birds in the tree.→There aren't any birds in the tree.
但是,若在表示请邀请、请求的句子中,some可以不变。如:
Would you like some orange juice?
与此相关的一些不定代词如something, somebody等也要进行相应变化。
2.and变为or。如:
I have a knife and a ruler.→I don't have a knife or a ruler.
3.a lot of (=lots of)变为many或much。如:
They have a lot of friends.(可数名词)→They don't have many friends.
There is lots of orange in the bottle.(不可数名词)
→There isn't much orange in the bottle.
4.already变为yet。如:
I have been there already.→I haven't been there yet.
16) in与after
in 与 after 都可以表示时间,但二者有所区别。
1.in 经常用于将来时的句子中,以现在为起点,表示将来一段时间。如:
He will leave for Beijing in a week. 一周后他会动身去北京。
2.after 经常用于过去时的句子中,以过去为起点,表示过去一段时间。如:
He left for Beijing after a week. 一周后他动身去了北京。
不过,如果after后跟的是具体的时刻,它也可用于将来时。如:
We will finish the work after ten o'clock.十点后我们会完成工作的。
3.注意区分以下的in的用法。
I'll visit him in a week. 一周后我会去拜访他。
I'll visit him twice in a week. 一周内我会去拜访他两次。
17) 不定冠词a与an的使用
1.a 用在以辅音音素开头的单词前。如:
There is a “b” in the word “book”. 单词book中有个字母b。
类似的字母还有:c, d, g, j, k, p, q, t, u, v, w, y, z。
She has a small knife. 她有一把小刀。
2.an 用于以元音音素开头的单词前。如:
There is an “i” in the word “onion”. 单词onion中有个字母i。
类似的字母还有:a, e, f, h, l, m, n, o, r, s, x。
Do you have an umbrella? 你有一把雨伞吗?
3.以元音字母开头的单词前面不一定都用an;以辅音字母开头的单词前面也不一定都用a.如:
a useful book
a universe
a one-letter word
an hour
an uncle
an umbrella
an honest person
18) 如何表达英语中的“穿、戴”?
英语中表示“穿、戴”的表达方法有好几种,常见的有以下这些:
1、put on 主要表达“穿”的动作。如:
He put on his coat.他穿上了他的外套。
You'd better put on your shoes.你最好穿上你的鞋子。
2、wear 主要表示“穿、戴”的状态。如:
The old man wears a pair of glasses.老人戴着一副眼镜。
The girl is wearing a red skirt.那女孩穿着一条红色的短裙。
3、dress 可作及物动词,有“给......穿衣”的意思,后接“人”,而不是
“衣服”。如:
Please dress the children right now.请立即给孩子们穿上衣服。
dress 也可作不及物动词,表示衣着的习惯。如:
The woman always dresses in green.那位妇女总是穿绿色的衣服。
4、be in 表示穿着的状态。如:
John is in white today.约翰今天穿白色的衣服。
The man in black is a football coach.
19) a little, a few 与 a bit (of)
a little, a few 与 a bit (of) 都有“一些、少量”的意义。他们的区别:
1. a little 意为“一些、少量”,后接不可数名词。如:
There is a little water in the bottle. 瓶子里有一点水。
还可以接形容词。如:
He is a little shy. 他有些害羞。
2. a few 意为“一些、少数”,后接复数的可数名词。如:
There are a few people in the room. 房间里有一些人。
3. a bit 意为“一点儿”,后接形容词。如:
It's a bit cold. 有点冷。
a bit of 后接不可数名词。如:
He has a bit of money. 他有一点儿钱。
4. a little和a few表肯定意义,little和few表否定意义;如:
There is a little soda in the glass. 杯子里有一点儿汽水。
There is little soda in the glass. 杯子里几乎没有汽水了。
I have a few Chinese friends. 我有一些中国朋友。
Few people like him. 几乎没有人喜欢他。
5. a little = a bit of, 后接不可数名词;
a little = a bit = a little bit = kind of, 后接形容词,意为“有
点儿”。
20) 关于like的用法
like 可以作动词,也可以作介词。
1、like 作动词,表示一般性的“爱好、喜欢”,有泛指的含义。如:
Do you like the color? 你喜爱这种颜色吗?
like 后可接不定式(like to do sth),也可接动词的-ing分词(like doing
sth),有时意思不尽相同。如:
She likes eating apples.她喜爱吃苹果。(习惯)
She likes to eat an apple.她喜爱吃一粒苹果。(平常不喜欢吃)
like 与 would 连用,后接不定式,表示愿望或客气的请求。如:
Would you like a cup of tea? 您愿意喝杯茶吗?
“喜欢某人做某事”可以用结构“like sb to do sth/doing sth”。如:
They all like me to sing/singing English songs.
他们都喜欢我唱英文歌。
2、like 作介词,可译成“像......”。如:
She is friendly to us like a mother.她对我们友好,就像母亲一样。
It looks like an orange.它看起来像个桔子。
3、区分以下句子:
A. What does he look like? 他长相如何?(指一个人的外貌特征)
B. What is he like? 他人怎么样? (指人的性格特点)
C. The boy like Peter is over there. (句指外貌相似)
D. A boy like Peter can't do it. (指性格相似)
21) stop to do sth 与 stop doing sth
1. stop to do sth 意为“停下来去做某事”。如:
The students stop to listen to their teacher.
学生们停下来去听他们老师讲话。
2. stop doing sth 意为“停止做某事”。如:
The students stopped talking. 学生们停止了谈话。
与它们相反的句式是:go on to do sth “继续做某事(与刚才一事不同)”
和 go on doing sth “继续做某事(与刚才同一件事)”。如:
He finishes his homework and goes on to study English.
他完成了作业,接着继续去念英语。
They went on playing games. 他们继续玩游戏。
22) tell, speak, say 与 talk
1. tell 意为“告诉、讲述”,指某人把某一件事、一条信息传送给别人或讲
述一件事。如:
He tells me that he wants to be a teacher.
他告诉我说他想成为一位教师。
Father always tells interesting stories to us.
爸爸总是给我们讲有趣的故事。
tell sb sth 意为“告知某人某事”。如:
He told me something about his past. 他告诉我一些他的往事。
tell sb to do sth 意为“告诉某人去做某事”。如:
David told his son to do the homework. 大卫要他的儿子去做作业。
2. speak 意为“说话、讲话”,后面主要接语言。如:
He can speak English and a little Chinese.
他能讲英语和一点汉语。
speak to 意为“和.....讲话、谈话”。如:
Can I speak to Mr Zhang? 我能和张先生讲话吗?
speak of 意为“提到、说起”。如:
The book speaks of my hometown. 那本书提到我的家乡。
3. talk 意为“谈话、讲话”,如果只有一方对另一方说话时,一般用 talk to;
如果双方或多方交谈,多用 with。如:
Please talk to him right now. 请立即同他谈话。
He is talking with his friend. 他在和朋友交谈。
talk about 意为“谈论......”。如:
They are talking about the movie. 他们在谈论那部电影。
have a talk with 意为“与......交谈”。如:
Can I have a talk with you? 我可以和你交谈吗?
4. say 意为“说”。如:
Can you say it in English once more? 你能用英语再说一遍吗?
say to 意为“对......说”。如:
He said to his students that they would have a test.
他对他的学生说他们将有一个测试。
It is said that... 意为“据说”。如:
It is said that he could stay under the water for a long time.
据说他能呆在水里很长时间。
23) Excuse me! 与 I'm sorry!
1. Excuse me! 意为“打搅了!对不起!”,一般是为了与陌生人搭话,或者要打断对方所说(做)的事。如:
Excuse me, is there a hotel in the neighborhood?
请问,附近有旅馆吗?
Excuse me, could I say something? 打搅一下,我能说一些吗?
2. I'm sorry! 意为“对不起!”,表示道歉。如:
I'm sorry, Mr Zhang. I won't do it again.
对不起,张先生。我不会这么做了。
24) 表示时间的 in、on 与 at
in, on 与 at 都可以和表示时间的词(组)连用。
1. in 表示时间的一段或较长的时间。如:
in the morning 在上午 in May, 在五月
in a week 在一周之内(后)
It's Sunday, I can finish it in two days.
现在是星期天,我能在两天后完成。(星期二)
Rome was not built in a day. 罗马不是在一天内建起来的。
2. on 主要指在具体的一天。如:
on Sunday 在星期天 on May Day 在“五一”节
on a hot afternoon 在一个炎热的下午
He arrived in Beijing on April 26,2004.
他于204月26日到达北京。
3. at 表示时间的一点或比较短的时间。如:
at 8:00 在八点 at noon 在中午
I always get up at 6:00 every morning. 我总是每天早晨六点起床。
It's always warm at this time of year. 每年的这个时候总是暖和的。
25) Other及其用法
Other 及其相近的词(组),如 others, the other, the others, another,
any other 等,一直是中学生朋友们比较困扰的问题,平常的考试、作业中经
常出错。下面是它们的一些用法:
1、other 指其余的人或物,所有格是 other's,复数形式是 others;the other
指“两个人或物中的另一个”,其复数形式是 the others;others相当于“other + 名词”,所以不能充当定语,修饰名词。others指整体中去掉一部分后剩余的部分,但不是全部的,即 some...others (一些...其余的人...);the others 强调整体中除去一部分后剩余的全部,即some...the others.
2、another泛指三个以上的不定数目中的“另外一个”。由 an 和 other 合
并构成,所以不能和冠词连用。another 修饰单数名词,比如:another pencil.
3、any other 指除去本身以外的“任何其他的人或物”,后面要用名词的单
数形式。
26) look 短语
常见的look短语有以下这些:
1.look at 朝......看 (look at=have a look at)
Please look at the map of China.请看中国地图。
2.look for 寻找
The old man is looking for his dog. 老人在寻找他的狗。
3.look like 看起来像
Nancy looks like her mother. 南希看起来像她母亲。
4.look the same 看上去一样
Li Ping and Li Jing look the same. 李萍和李晶看上去一样。
5.look up 查找
Please look up the word in the dictionary.请在词典中查找这个单词。
6.look over 仔细检查
The doctor looked over Mary carefully. 医生仔细检查了玛丽。
7.look after 照顾,照看
You must look after your old father. 你必须照顾你的老父亲。
8.look around 到处寻找、查看
We looked around, but we found nothing strange.
我们四处查看,但是我们没有发现奇怪的东西。
27) too,also与either
1.too用于肯定句和疑问句,一般放在句尾,其前常加逗号。如:
We are in the same school, too. 我们也在相同的学校。
Do you play soccer every day, too? 你也每天踢足球吗?
2.also用于肯定句和疑问句,一般位于实义动词前、be动词后。如:
Sandra is also a Korean student. Sandra 也是一个韩国学生。
3.either用于否定句,一般放在句末。如:
They don't know the answer, either. 她们也不知道答案。
4.as well as也有“也”的意思。如:
We have great mushroom pizza as well as soda.
He is a happy boy as well.
28) hard与hardly
1.hard既可作形容词,也可作副词。如:
It's a hard (adj.) question. (=difficult) 这是一个难的问题。
The boy studies very hard (adv.). 那男孩学习非常努力。
句子结构:It's hard for sb to do sth 做某事对某人来说是难的。如:
It's hard for him to finish the work. 完成那项工作对他来说很难。
注意区分:hard work 困难的工作
work hard 努力工作
3. hardly是频度副词,表示否定的意思。(=almost not)通常用在形容词、
副词和动词之前。如:
I can hardly see it. 我几乎看不到它。
29) sometime,sometimes,some time与some times
记忆:sometimes(有时)some times(好几次)sometime(某一次)some time(一段)
口诀:有s是有时,有时分开好几次,无s是某时,某时分开是一段。
1.sometime是时间副词,指不确定的将来或过去某一点时间(某时候或任何
时候),不指一段时间。如:
We'll go to Beijing sometime next month.
我们下个月某一时候会去北京。
2.sometimes是频度副词,指“有时”、“不时”的意思(=at times)。如:
Sometimes I get up very late on Sunday morning.
有时候我在星期天早晨起得很晚。
3.some time是名词词组,指一段时间(一些时间或若干时间)。如:
It took him some time to finish the book.她花了一些时间去完成作业。
4.some times指“几次”。如:
He met the woman some times last month. 上个月他见过那妇女几次。
30) exercise的一些用法
1.作不及物动词,译为“运动,锻炼”。如:
David exercises every morning. 大卫每天早晨进行锻炼。
2.作及物动词,译为“训练”。如:
Swimming exercises the whole body. 游泳能使身体得到全面的锻炼。
3.作名词,译为“体育锻炼、运动、体操、练习题”等。如:
It's good to do eye exercises every day.
每天做眼保键操对眼睛有好处。
Please do more exercise from now on. 从今以后请多做运动吧。
I have lots of homework to do tonight. 今晚我有很多的作业要做。
4.注意:exercise指具体运动或体操时是可数名词,复数形式为exercises;
泛指运动时是不可数名词。
31) maybe与may be
1.maybe是副词,译为“也许、可能”,相当于“perhaps”。如:
Maybe he can answer the question. 也许他能回答那个问题。
He maybe is from the USA, too. 他可能也来自美国。
2.may be中的may为情态动词,译为“可能是......”。如:
He may be from the USA, too. 他可能也来自美国。
She may be our English teacher. 她可能是我们的英语老师。
32) same与different
1.same指“相同的”,前面通常要有一个定冠词the,但是如果same前面已
经有this,those等词,就不能再与the连用了。如:
We are in the same class. 我们在同一个班级。
结构:the same as 与......一样 如:
His mark is the same as mine. 他的分数和我的分数一样。
2.different译为“不同的”,其后的可数名词应为复数形式。如:
We are in different classes. 我们在不同的班级。
结构:be different from 与......不同 如:
This sweater is different from that one. 这件毛衣与那一件不同。
different的名词形式为difference, 复数形式为differences。
33) 动词want的用法
1. want sth. 想要某物
They want some help. 他们需要一些帮助。
2. want sb. to do sth. 想要某人去做某事
My father wants me to help him on the farm.我父亲要我在农场上帮他。
3. want to do sth. 想要做某事
I want to study English in England. 我想要在英国学习英语。
4.want doing 需要...
Your sweater wants washing. 你的运动衣该洗了。
34) be good(bad) for、be good at的相关用法
1.be good for 对......有益
Doing morning exercises is good for your health.
做早操对你们的建康有益。
2.be good at 擅长于......
Li Ping is good at basketball. 李平擅长于篮球。
= Li Ping is good at playing basketball. 李平擅长于打篮球。
be good at = do well in 如:
I'm good at math. = I do well in math. 我擅长于数学。
3.be good to 对......好
Parents are always good to their children.
父母亲总是对他们的孩子好。
35) how many与how much
1.how many表示“多少”,对数量提问,后面接可数名词的复数形式。如:
There are four people in my family.
---How many people are in your family? 你家里有几个人?
We have seven classes every day.
---How many classes do you have every day? 你们每天上几节课?
2.how much也是表示“多少”,但它对不可数名词进行提问。如:
There is some milk in the bottle.
---How much milk is there in the bottle? 瓶子里有多少牛奶?
3.how much还可以对价格提问,表示“多少钱”的意思。如:
The yellow T-shirt is only 35 yuan.
---How much is the yellow T-shirt? 那件黄色的T恤衫多少钱?
36) with的几个用法
1.with表“和、同、与”。如:
Can you go to the park with me? 你能和我一起去公园吗?
2.with表“用、以、被”。如:
Don't write with the red pen. 不要用那支红色的钢笔写字。
3.with表“随着”。如:
Climate varies with the time of the year.气候随着时令的不同而不同。
4.with表“带有、有......的”。如:
The girl with long hair is my classmate. 长头发的女孩是我的同学。
5.with表“因为、由于”。如:
They were angry with hard work. 他们因为艰难的工作而生气。
6.一些with结构:
play with 与......一起玩
be angry with 对......生气
talk with 与......交谈
get on well with与......相处融洽
37) a lot of(lots of)与many,much
1.a lot of意为“许多、大量”,相当于lots of.它既可以修饰可数名词,又
可以修饰不可数名词。如:
I have a lot of friends in China. 我在中国有很多朋友。
The old man has lots of money. 那位老人有很多的钱。
2.many意为“许多”.它用来修饰可数名词。如:
Do you have many beautiful skirts? 你有很多漂亮的裙子吗?
3.much意为“大量”.它用来修饰不可数名词。如:
There is much water in the lake. 湖里有大量的水。
4.a lot of(=lots of)用在肯定句中,而many,much不受限制。如果将一
个含有a lot of(=lots of)的肯定句改为否定句或疑问句,要将它们
改为many或much。如:
We can see a lot of birds in the tree.
---We can't see many birds in the tree. 我们在树上看不到很多鸟儿。
He wants lots of soda.
---Does he want much soda? 他需要许多汽水吗?
38) help用法举例
help既可以作名词,也可以作动词。
1.help作名词,意为“帮助”。如:
He needs some help. 他需要一些帮助。
2.help作动词,也是“帮助”的意思。如:
Can you help me? 你能帮帮我吗?
3.help的结构:
help sb (to) do sth 帮助某人做某事
=help sb with sth 帮助某人做某事
如:They want to help the boy carry the heavy box.
=They want to help the boy with the heavy box.
他们想要帮助那位男孩搬那个重箱子。
39) well的用法
well可以作副词,也可以作形容词。
1.well作副词,意为“(某事干得)好”。如:
The boy draws very well. 男孩画得很好。
2.well作形容词,意为“健康、安好”。如:
I'm not feeling well. 我觉得不舒服。
40) ago与before
ago与before都表示“......以前”,但用法有所区别。
1.ago意为“以前”,表示从此刻算起的若干时间之前,常用于过去时的句子
中。如:He took a photo a week ago. 他一周前照了一张相片。
2.before作为副词时表示:
a.从过去某一时刻算起的若干时间以前,用于过去完成时的句子中。如:
The boy had already seen the comedy before.
那男孩以前已经看过那部喜剧片了。
b.笼统的“以前”,用于一般过去时或现在完成时的句子中,一般单独使
用,而ago不可以单独使用。如:
He's read this novel before. 他以前读过这部小说。
41) need的用法
1.need作实义动词,意为“需要”。如:
Do you need to stay at home? 你要呆在家里吗?
2.need作情态动词,一般用于对must的否定回答。如:
---Must he leave now? 他必须离开吗?
---No, he needn't. 不,他不必。
3.区分:
a.need作实义动词。
He needs to go.
He doesn't need to go.
Does he need to go?
Yes, he does./No, he doesn't.
b.need作情态动词,一般不用于肯定句。
He needn't go.
Need he go?
Yes, he need./No, he needn't.
42) decide的几种句式
1.decide to do sth 决定去做某事
They decide to fly kite on weekend. 他们决定在周末去放风筝。
2.decide on doing sth 决定做某事
They decide on flying kites. 他们决定放风筝。
3.decide on sth 就某事决定......
Betty decided on the red skirt. 贝蒂选定了那条红裙子。
4. decide的名词形式为decision,
结构:make a decision,意为“做决定”。如:
He has made a decision. 他已经做一个决定了。
43) too many,too much与much too
1.too many意为“太多”,用于修饰可数名词的复数。如:
There are too many students in our class. 我们班上有太多的学生。
2.too much意为“太多”,用于修饰不可数名词。如:
We have too much work to do. 我们有太多的工作要做。
3.much too表示“太”,用来修饰形容词或副词。如:
The box is much too heavy, so I can't carry it.
箱子太重了,所以我搬不动它。
44) can的用法
1.表示能力。如:
We can carry the heavy box. 我们可以搬得动箱子。
Who can sing an English song? 谁会唱英文歌?
2.表示惊讶、不相信等态度,主要用于否定句和疑问句中。如:
Can it be true? 这会是真的吗?
You can't be serious? 你不会当真吧?
3.表示允许,意思与may相近,主要用于口语中。如:
Can I smoke here? 我可以在这儿吸烟吗?
Can I go with him? 我可以跟他一起去吗?
新目标八年级英语上册第一单元复习
I. 应掌握的词组:
1. go to the movies 去看电影
2. look after=take care of 照顾
3. surf the internet 上网
4. healthy lifestyle 健康的生活方式
5. go skate boarding 去划板
6. keep healthy=stay healthy 保持健康
7. exercise=take (much) exercise
=do sports锻炼
8. eating habits 饮食习惯
9. take more exercise 做更多的运动
10. the same as 与什么相同
11. once a month一月一次
12. be different from 不同
13. twice a week一周两次
14. make a difference to 对什么有影响
15. how often 多久一次
16. although=though虽然
17. most of the students=most students
大多数学生
18. shop=go shopping
=do some shopping 购物
19. as for至于
20. activity survey活动调查
21. do homework做家庭作业
22. do house work做家务事
23. eat less meat吃更少的肉
24. junk food垃圾食物
25. be good for 对什么有益
26. be bad for对什么有害
27. want to do sth 想做某事
28. want sb to do sth想某人做某事
29. try to do sth 尽量做某事
30. come home from school放学回家
31. of course=certainly=sure当然
32. get good grades取得好成绩
33. some advice
34. help sb to do sth帮助某人做某事
=help sb with sth
35. a lot of vegetables
=many vegetables许多蔬菜
36. hardly=not nearly / almost not几乎不
37. keep/be in good health保持健康
II. 应掌握的句子:
1. How often do you exercise? 你(你们)多久锻炼一次身体?
How often + 助动词do(does或did) + 主语 + do sth.? 疑问词how often是问频率(多久一次),(在这里助动词do(does或did) 是起帮助构成疑问的作用)与一般现在时或一般过去时连用,回答一般是用表示频率的副词,如:once, twice, three times…, sometimes, often, quite, often, never, every day, once a week , twice a month , three times a month , three or four times a month 等。
翻译:“你们多久到工厂去一次?”“每星期两次。”
(“How often do you go to the factory?” “Twice a week. ”)
“他们多长时间举办一次舞会?”“通常每两周举办一次。”
(“How often do they have a dancing party?” “Usually, once every other week.”)
“他多久去购一次物?”“一个月一次。”
(“How often does he go shopping?” “He goes shopping once a month.”)
2. “What do you usually do on weekends?” “ I usually play soccer.”
“周末你通常做什么?”“我通常踢足球。”
第一个do为助动词, 在这起帮助构成疑问的作用;而第二个do则是实义动词。
翻译:What do you usually do on weekends? I often go to the movies.
What does she usually do on weekends? She sometimes go hiking.
3. “What’s your favorite program?” “It’s Animal World.”
“你最喜欢什么节目?”“动物世界。”
4. As for homework , most students do homework every day .
as for...意思是“至于;关于”,常用于句首作状语,其后跟名词、代词或动词的
-ing形式(即动名词)。如:
As for him,I never want to see him here. 至于他,我永远不希望在这里见到。
As for the story,you'd better not believe it. 关于那故事,你最好不要相信。
翻译:至于我自己,我现在不想去。
(As for myself, I don’t want to go now. )
至于那个人,我什么都不知道。
(As for the man, I know nothing about him.)
5. Mom wants me to get up at 6:00 and play ping-pong with her .
want to do sth. 意思是“想要做某事”;
want sb. to do sth.意思是“想要某人做某事”。如:
Do you want to go to the movies with me?你想和我一起去看电影吗?
The teacher doesn't want us to eat hamburgers.老师不想让我们吃汉堡包。
6. She says it’s good for my health.
be good for...表示“对……有益(有好处)”;其反义为:be bad for...。(这里for 是
介词,后跟名词、代词或动名词)如:
It's good for us to do more reading. 多读书对我们有好处。
Reading in bed is bad for your eyes.在床上读书对你的眼睛有害。
7. How many hours do you sleep every night?
8. I exercise every day , usually when I come home from school .
9. My eating habits are pretty good . 这里pretty相当于very 。
10. I try to eat a lot of vegetables , usually ten to eleven times a week .
try to do sth.表示“ 尽力做某事 ” ,不包含是否成功的意思而try doing sth.表示
“(用某一办法)试着去做某事”。如:
You’d better try doing the experiment in another way.
你最好试试用另一种方法做这个试验。
11. My healthy lifestyle helps me get good grades.
help sb.(to) do sth.帮助某人做某事
12. Good food and exercise help me to study better.
这里better是well的比较级,而不是good的比较级
13. Is her lifestyle the same as yours or different?
=Is her lifestyle the same as your lifestyle or is her lifestyle different from yours? be the same as … / be different from …
14. What sports do you play ?
15. A lot of vegetables help you to keep in good health .
keep in good health = keep healthy = stay healthy
16. You must try to eat less meat .
try to do sth.表示“ 尽力做某事 ” ,不包含是否成功的意思,less是little的比较级
17. That sounds interesting.
这是“主语+系动词+表语”结构的简单句。sound(听起来),look(看起来),smell
(闻起来),taste(尝起来),feel(觉得),seem(好象),grow(变得),get
(变得)等词在英语中可用作系动词,后跟形容词作表语。如:
It tastes good. 这味道好。
The music sounds very sweet. 这音乐听起来很入耳。
The smoke grew heavier and heavier. 烟雾变得越来越浓了。
新目标八年级英语上册第二单元复习
I. 应掌握的词组:
1. Have a cold 感冒 2. sore back 背痛
3. neck and neck 并驾齐驱,齐头并进
4. I have a stomachache 我胃痛
= I have got a stomachache
=There is something wrong with my stomach
= My stomach hurts = I have (got) a pain in my stomach
5. What’s the matter? 怎么了?
= What’s the trouble (with you)? = What’s your trouble?
= What’s wrong (with you)? =What’ the matter (with you)?
=What has happened to you? =Is there anything wrong (with you)?
= what’s up?
6. sore throat 咽喉痛
7. lie down and rest 躺下休息
8. see a dentist 看牙医
9. drink lots of water 多喝水
10. hot tea with honey 加蜂蜜的热茶
11.That’s a good idea 好主意
12.That’s too bad 太糟糕了
13.I think so 我认为如此
14. I’m not feeling well. 我觉得不太舒服
= I’m not feeling fine/all right. = I’m feeling ill/sick. =I feel terrible/bad.
= I don’t feel well.
15. get some rest 多休息
16. I have no idea = I don’t know
我不知道
17. stressed out 筋疲力尽
18. I am tired 我累了
He is tired. 他累了
19. a healthy lifestyle健康的生活方式
20. traditional Chinese doctors传统中医
21. a balance of yin and yang阴阳调和
22. you have too much yin.你阴气太盛
23. to eat a balance diet饮食平衡
24.healthy food 健康食品
25. stay healthy 保持健康=keep healthy=keep in good health = keep fit
26. enjoy oneself (myself, yourself, herself, himself, themselves, ourselves, itself
反身代词) 玩得高兴,过得愉快=have a good time = have a wonderful time
=have fun
27. enjoy sth. =like sth. (名词)喜欢某物,
enjoy doing sth.喜欢做某事=like dong sth
Practice doing sth.练习做某事,
mind doing sth. 介意做某事,
finish doing sth.完成某事,
give up doing sth.放弃做某事,
can’t help doing sth.忍不住做某事,
keep ding sth. 坚持做某事.
即:practice, mind, finish, give up, can’t help, keep 与enjoy用法基本相似
28.at the moment = now 此刻
29. Host family 东道家庭
30. Conversation practice会话练习
31.I’m sorry to hear that.听到此事我很难过
II. 应掌握的句子:
1. What’s the matter? I have a bad cold. 你怎么了?我得了重感冒。
翻译:他怎么了?他胃痛。
魏芳怎么了?她背痛。
2.Maybe you should see a dentist. 或许你应该看牙医。
翻译:我应该上床睡觉。
李平应该躺下休息。
我们不应该上课吃东西。
3.I hope you feel better soon. 我希望你很快好起来。
翻译:我希望他明天能来。
他希望能取得好成绩。
我们希望能取得一等奖。
我希望你喜欢我在纽约的学校。
4.Traditional Chinese doctors believe we need a balance of yin and yang to be healthy. 传统中医认为我们需要阴阳调和以保持身体健康。
翻译:老师认为我们应该努力学习以取得好成绩。
父母认为我们应该上大学以便得到一份好的工作。
你应该做锻炼来保持健康。
我相信每天晚上睡眠8个小时很重要。
吃均衡饮食以保持健康。
5.Eating Dangshen and Huangqi herbs is also good for this.
吃党参和黄芪等草本植物也对这有好处。
翻译:吃一些蔬菜和水果对你的健康有好处。
看电视太多对你的眼睛有害。
6.People who are too stressed out and angry may have too much yang.
太紧张易怒的人或许吃了太多的阳性食物。
7.It’s easy to have a healthy lifestyle, and it’s important to eat a balanced diet.
有一个健康的生活方式很容易,饮食平衡是很重要的。
翻译:学好英语不是很容易的。
上课注意听讲是必要的。
完成作业也很重要。
8.When you are tired, you shouldn’t go out at night. 疲倦时,晚上你不该外出。
翻译:他小的时候就知道应该努力学习。
他5岁就上学了。
我们进教室时,老师已经开始讲课了。
9.I believe him, but I can’t believe in him.
他的话是真的,但是我不信任他这个人。
10.I am not feeling very well at the moment. 这段时间我感觉不大好。
I’m tired and I have a lot of headaches. 我很疲劳,而且经常头痛。
11.I’m stressed out because my Mandarin isn’t improving.
我很容易紧张,因为普通话没有长进。
12.I practice playing the piano every day.我每天练习弹钢琴。
翻译:他每天练习踢足球。
我们应该每天练习说英语。
我们应该经常联系用英语写日记。
13.She had finished writing the letter when I went in.
我进去时,她已经写完信了。
翻译:他踢完足球去游泳了。
我洗完餐具后去商店了。
14.The doctor asked him to give up smoking.医生叫他戒烟。
翻译:不要放弃学英语。
15.Do you mind closing the window? 请把窗户关上好吗?
翻译:在这里吸烟你介意吗?
16.Mary couldn’t help laughing at his jokes.对于他的玩笑,玛莉忍不住笑了。
翻译:听到这个消息,我忍不住哭了起来。
17.They kept working though it was raining.尽管天在下雨,他们仍坚持工作。
翻译:我们应该坚持学英语。
新目标八年级英语第三单元复习
I.应掌握的词组:
1. babysit one’s sister 照顾妹妹
2. visit one’s grandmother 看望奶奶
3. spend time with friends
和朋友们一起度过时光
4. visit cousins 看望表弟等
5. Go to sports camp 去运动野营
6.go to the beach 去海滩
7. go camping 去野营
8. Go shopping 去买东西
9. go swimming 去游泳
10. go boating去划船
11. go skating 去溜冰
12. go walking去散步
13. go climbing 去登山
14. go dancing去跳舞
15. go hiking 去徒步远足
16. go sightseeing 去观光
17. go house-hunting 去找房子
18.go on a hike 徒步旅行,go bike riding 骑自行车旅行,go fishing 去钓鱼
19. do some shopping 买东西
20. do some washing 洗衣服
21. do some cooking 作饭
22. do some reading 读书
23. do some speaking训练口语
24. do some sewing 做缝纫活
25.that sounds nice 那好极了
26. at home 在家
27. how about=what about ……
怎么样?
28. how long 多长时间
29. how far 多远
30. how often 多长时间一次
31. how much, how many 多少
32. have a good time =have fun= have a wonderful time= enjoy oneself
玩得高兴,过得愉快
33. show sb. Sth.=show sth. to sb.出示某物给某人看
give me the book=give the book to me 给我书,
pass me the cup=pass the cup to me 把杯子递给我,
sell me the house=sell the house to me 把房子卖给我
buy me a book =buy a book for me 给我买书,
make me a cake=make a cake for me给我做蛋糕
34. get back=come back回来
35. rent videos租借影碟
36. take walks=go for a walk散步
37. think about 考虑
38. decide on= decide upon
决定一个计划
39. something different 不同的事情
40.a great vacation 一个愉快的假期
41. I can’t wait 我等不及了
42. the famous movie star 著名的影星
43. an exciting vacation
激动人心的假期
44. Ask her about her plans 向她询问她的计划ask sb. about sth.向某人询问某事
45. forget to do sth. 忘记要做某事,forget doing sth. 忘记做过某事
II.应该掌握的句子:
1.What are you doing for vacation? I’m babysitting my sister.
假期你要做什么?我要照顾我的妹妹。
翻译:周末他要做什么?他要去滑划板。
李平假期要做什么?他要去野营。
2.Who are you going with? I’m going with my parents.
你要和谁一起去?我要和父母一起去。
翻译:王林要和谁一起去观光?他要和他的朋友们一起去。
我要和同学们一起去游泳。
我和父母要去游览长城。
他们假期要做什么?他们要在家里放松放松。
3.When is he going camping? He is going on the 12th of February, .
4.I’m going to Tibet for a week. 我要去西藏一周。
翻译:你要去西藏多长时间?
他们假期要在家里呆一个月。
你要在香港呆多长时间?只呆4天,我不喜欢离开太长时间。
5.What are you doing there? I’m going hiking in the mountains.
你在那里要做什么? 我要在山区里远足。
6.Show me your photos when we get back to school.
我们返回学校时,你把照片拿给我看。
翻译:我来把我的新照片拿给你看看。
他长大时想当一名时装杂志的记者。
7.Where are you going for vacation? I’m going to Hawaii for vacation.
你要去哪度假?我要去夏威夷度假。
翻译:他要去哪度假?他要去泰国度假。
8.I’m going to Hawaii for vacation in December, and I’m staying for three weeks.我要在12月去夏威夷度假,在那里呆3个星期。
翻译:他打算在11月2日去海南度假,在那呆大约1个月。
9.What is it like there? 那里什么样子?
翻译:那部电视剧怎么样?
那里的天气怎么样?
你和谁一起去?
你要呆多长时间?
10. Can I ask you some questions about your vacation plans?
我可以问你一些有关你假期计划的问题吗?
翻译:我能吃点肉吗?
他向我打听你家的情况。
11. He thought about going to Greece or Spain, but decided on Canada.
他考虑去希腊或西班牙,但是最后他决定去加拿大。
翻译:我总是在欧洲读假。
这次,我想有所改变。
我听说加拿大风景优美,而且我知道那里也有很多人说法语。
12. He is leaving the first week in June and staying until September.
他将在6月的第一个星期动身,一直呆到9月。
翻译:他想度过一个轻松的假期。
我想要过一个令人兴奋的假期。
我计划去美丽的乡村度过这段时间。
13. Please don’t forget to close the door when you leave.
你离开时,请别忘记关门。
14.She couldn’t wait to get home to see he parents.
她迫不及待的想回家看望父母。
翻译:我听说泰国是一个观光游览的好地方。
她星期二动身去香港。
我想要问你有关在中国旅游地点的问题。
八年级英语第四单元复习
I.应掌握的词组:
1.get to school 到校
2. get home 到家
3. how about=what about
…….怎么样?
4.take the subway 乘地铁
5.ride a bike 骑自行车
6.take the bus乘公共汽车
7.take the train乘火车
8.take a taxi乘坐出租车
9. go in a parent’s car 坐父母的车
10. by bike, bike bus,
by subway, by taxi,
by car, by train
(乘坐……车,放在句尾)
11. have a quick breakfast
迅速吃早饭
12. the early bus 早班车
13. how far多远
14. take sb. to sp.带某人到某处
15. doing sth. takes sb. Some time/ money
=It takes sb. some time/money to do sth.
=sb. spends dome time/money (on sth.)
=sb. spends some time/money (in) doing sth.
=sth. costs sb. some time/money
=sb. pay some money for sth.
花费某人多少时间/金钱做某事/某人花费多少金钱/时间做某事
16. bus stop公共汽车站,
train station火车站,
subway station地铁站,
bus station客运站
17. want to do sth.想做某事
18.walk to school 步行上学
19. in North America 在北美
20. in other parts of the world
在世界的其他地区
21. depend on=depend upon
依靠,靠……决定
22. not all 不是所有的
23. need to do sth.需要做某事
24. number of students学生数
25. a number of=many 许多number前可用large, great, small修饰其谓语是复数26.the number of….的数量,谓语是单数
27. don’t worry(about sth./sb.)别着急(为某人/事担心
28. around the world= all over the world世界各地,全世界
II.应掌握的句子:
1. How do you get to school? I walk to school.你是怎样到校的?我步行。
翻译:你们如何去上海?我乘飞机去,他坐火车去。
李平怎样到校的?骑自行车。
火车什么时候到站?
我们是今天早上到上海的。
2. How about the white shirt? 这件白衬衫怎么样?
翻译:他怎么样?
去游泳怎么样?
3. I usually walk but sometimes I take the bus.我通常步行,但有时坐公共汽车。
翻译:他总是骑自行车上学,但这次他乘地铁上学了。
4. How long does it take you to get to school? It takes about 10 minutes to walk and 15 minutes by bus.你需要多长时间到校?步行大约10分钟,乘汽车15分钟。
翻译:做早操每天花费他半小时。
建造这座桥工人们将花费1年多的时间。
我花了20分钟做作业。
这件新外套花了我母亲80元钱。
他花了20美圆买这个新玩具。
5. How far is it from his home to school? About 10 kilometers.
从他家到学校有多远?大约10公里。
翻译:从地球到月球有多远?大约38万公里远。
本溪到沈阳有多远?大约70公里远。
6. Lin Fei’s home is about 10 kilometers from school.林飞的家离学校大约10公里
翻译:我们学校到望溪公园大约7公里。
7. He leaves for school at around six-thirty. 他大约在6点30分动身去学校。
翻译:你什么时候离开本溪的?
我们下星期去北京。
我们不会离开北京到大连市。
8. Then the early bus takes him to school.然后,他乘坐早班车到学校。
翻译:他们李平送到医院。
请把书带到学校来。
张强把水果从书包里拿了出来。
我打算带一些苹果回家。
9. Thomas wants to know where Nina lives.托马斯想要知道尼娜住在哪里。
翻译:老师想知道她住的地方离学校有多远。
李平想知道到学校需要多长时间。
他们想知道他通常怎样到校。
我想知道她认为交通怎么样。
10. In Japan, most students take trains to school, although others also walk or ride their bikes. 在日本,大部分学生乘坐火车上学,尽管其他人也步行或骑自行车。
翻译:在中国,这要看你住在哪里。
在大城市,学生通常骑自行车或乘坐公共汽车上学。
在有河流或湖泊的地区,学生们通常坐船上学。
那一定要比乘坐公共汽车要有趣得多。
在北美地区,不是所有的学生都乘坐公共汽车上学。
世界的其它地区与美国不同。
在日本,到校的三个最常用的交通方式是:公共汽车,火车和自行车。
在中国,自行车和公共汽车是最常用的交通方式。
11. A small number of students take the subway to school.
小部分学生乘坐地铁上学
翻译:我有许多信件要写。
我们学校许多学生来自农村。
说汉语的人的数量要大于说英语的人的数量。
12. What do you think of the transportation in your town?
你对你们镇的交通认为怎么样?
翻译:你认为这本书怎么样?
下雨时,我乘坐出租车。
你住的离学校有多远?
13. She is dead but her memory still lives on.她虽然死了,但人们仍然怀念她。
翻译:羊靠青草维持生命。
八年级英语第五单元复习
I.应掌握的词组:
e to one’s party
参加某人的聚会
2. on Saturday afternoon
在星期六的下午
3. I’d love to 我非常乐意
4. I’m sorry 对不起
5. study for a test为测验而学习
6.go to the doctor 去看医生
7.visit one’s aunt 看望某人的姑姑
8.have a piano lesson 上一堂钢琴课
9. go to one’s guitar lesson
去上吉他课
10. too much homework
太多家庭作业
11. much too interesting 有趣得多
12.maybe another time 也许下一次吧
13.Thanks for asking(inviting)
谢谢邀请
14.go to the baseball game
参加棒球比赛
15.Birthday Party 生日聚会
16.go to the mall 去购物中心
17. soccer practice 足球练习
18. look for 寻找
19. find out 找到,弄清楚,查明
20.studu for the math test
为数学考试而学习
21. play tennis with me
和我一起打网球
23. I have a really busy week
我一周很忙
24. my cousin’s birthday party
我表弟的生日聚会
25. write soon 尽快回信
26.study for my science test
为科学考试而学习
27.给某人打电话的几种说法:
call sb. up,
call sb.,
phone sb.,
phone to sb.,
telephone sb.,
telephone to sb.,
phone sb. up,
ring sb.,
give sb. a ring,
give sb. a phone,
make a telephone call to sb.
28. on Thursday night 星期四晚上
29. be (go) on vacation 度假
30.next week下周
31.join sb.加入某人一起
32. Please keep quiet! 请保持安静, keep+形容词表示“保持某种状态”,
keep+(sb.)+doing 表示“(使某人)不停地做某事”,keep sth. 保存某物
33.football match足球比赛
34. culture club 文化俱乐部
35. try to do sth. 努力(企图)做某事,
try doing sth.试着做某事,
try one’ best to do sth. 尽力做某事
II.应掌握的句子:
1. Can you come to my party on Saturday afternoon? Sure, I’d love to.
星期六的下午你能来参加我的聚会吗?当然,我非常乐意。
翻译:你能在星期三来参加我的聚会吗?对不起,我不能去,我得帮助我的父母。
星期四他们能和我一起去看电影吗?不能,他们有太多的作业要做。
星期天你能和我一起去看电影吗?对不起,我得去看我的姑姑。
星期一李平能来上学吗?不能,他要去看医生。
他能干大事。 他会那样做的。
2. May I ask you some questions? Sure. / Of course. /Certainly.
我可以问您一些问题吗?当然可以。
翻译:我能帮你做这件事吗?当然可以。
我能用一下您的钢笔吗?当然可以。
杰克,我们去踢球吧。好主意。
今天晚上你准备做什么?没什么事。
3. I would love to go to your party. 我愿意参加你的聚会。
翻译:你想要喝茶还是咖啡?
我想要一千克大米。
我想要见见她。
吴老师想要我在会上发言。
我倒是希望明天能来,但恐怕来不了。
4. She isn’t very well these days and has to stay home.
她这几天身体不太好,只好呆在家里。
翻译:他知道她必须做什么以及需要什么。
我们必须去帮助他摆脱困境。
5. We can learn what we did not know. 我们能够学会原来不知道的东西。
翻译:我去年学会滑冰的。
我想学好英语。
我们要学会互相帮助。
我们应该学会如何学习。
6. Thank you for inviting me. =Thanks for asking (having, inviting)
谢谢你邀请我。
翻译:谢谢你的帮助。
感谢你照顾我妹妹。
上周日他邀请我参加他的生日聚会。
他没有邀请她同他们一起就餐。
谢谢你们来看我。
7. Maybe another time.或许下一次吧。
翻译:请再给我一块蛋糕好吗?
这件外套太小,请再给我拿一件。
我有支钢笔,一支给你,一支个吉姆,另一支给汤姆。
这儿有两根尺子,一根很短,另一根很长。
汤姆的脚一只比另一只大。
吉姆和杰克在教室里看书,其他学生在活动。
8. Can she go to the movies? No, she can’t. She’s playing soccer.
她能去看电影吗?不,她不能。她要踢足球。
翻译:他们能去音乐会吗?不,他们不能。他们要区参加聚会。
9. Read these dialogues and find out about another kind of football.
朗读这些对话,找出有关另一种足球的语句。
翻译:我去查一下火车什么时候到。
10. She and I are both students. 我和她都是学生。
翻译:我们俩都必须学好英语。
我们应该感谢你们俩。
星期五晚上,我要和一些朋友一起去看电影。
星期三,我要和校球队一起打网球。
我的美国朋友下一个假期要来看望我。
我不能加入你们一起,因为我得帮助我母亲。
你能在星期三的晚上来我们家与我们一起讨论科学报告吗?
八年级英语第六单元复习
I.应掌握的词组:
1. long hair 长头发
2.How are you? 你身体好吗?
3. How old 多大年纪
4. how tall 多高
5. how long ago多久前(的事)
6.more outgoing 比较外向
7. want/plan to do sth. 意欲,企图
8.here are photos of me 这是我的照片
9. as you can see 正如你所看到的
10.in some ways在某些地方
11. we look the same我们看起来一样,
They look different他们看起来不?
八年级上册英语课件 篇4
教案反思是教学过程中非常重要的一个环节,能够帮助教师更好地了解教学的不足之处,并及时纠正,从而提高教学质量。以下是一些有关八年级英语上册教案反思的建议:
1. 确定教学目标:在开始教学之前,教师应该清楚地确定教学目标,以便在课堂上引导学生朝着特定的方向前进。例如,教学目标可以包括提高学生的词汇量、提高听力技能、提高阅读理解能力等。
2. 设计有趣的教学内容:有趣的教学内容可以吸引学生的注意力,让他们更加积极地参与课堂活动。教师可以通过使用图片、视频、游戏等多媒体形式来设计教学内容。
3. 提供充分的练习机会:在课堂上,教师应该提供充分的练习机会,让学生通过练习来巩固所学知识。例如,教师可以设计单词拼写和阅读理解练习等。
4. 鼓励小组合作:小组合作可以帮助学生更好地理解知识点,并且可以培养学生的团队合作能力。教师可以在教学过程中鼓励小组合作,并设定奖励机制来激励学生。
5. 关注学生的反馈:在课堂结束后,教师应该关注学生的反馈,了解他们是否掌握了所学知识。如果教师发现学生需要更多练习,教师应该及时进行补充。
总结起来,教案反思可以帮助教师更好地了解教学的不足之处,并及时纠正,从而提高教学质量。
八年级上册英语课件 篇5
【学习目标】
1.学生学会关于假期去旅行的一些常用词汇与句型,并学会复合不定代词的用法。
2.通过与学生交流假期去哪里旅行的话题,提升学生的语言交际能力。
3.学生会用一般过去时态进行信息交流,形成环保意识,热爱大自然。
【学习重点】
学生能用所学的功能语言交流假期去了什么地方旅行。
【学习难点】
学习复合不定代词someone,anyone,something,anything等的用法。
Learning action tips: leading in by showing PPT about the students’holiday trip.
Topics:Did you have a good time during the vacation?Yes,Idid. Did you go anywhere interesting with your parents?Can you tell us where you went on vacation?……Review the past tense.
Task 1
Learning action tips: Preview the words on Page2 in the word list. Studentsread the words by phonetic symbols, then underline new words in the text and markthe Chinese meaning. At last finish the task in 1a.
【知识链接】
1.复合不定代词有:
某人someone
任何人anyone
没有人no one
每个人everyone
某事something
任何事anything
没有东西nothing
一切everything
2.anyone与any one的区别
anyone通常指人,侧重于个体,后面不带of;any one既指人,又指物,侧重于整体,后面可接of。情景导入 生成问题
1.T:Didyou have a good time during the vacation?
S:________________________________________________________________________
2.T:Wheredid you go on vacation?
S:________________________________________________________________________
自学互研 生成能力
Task1Let\'sread the new words and the phrases.
1.I can read.(我会读)
anyone,anywhere,wonderful,quite a few,most
2.I can write.(我会写)
翻译下列短语:
(1)待在家里stay__at__home(2)去纽约城go__to__New__York__City
(3)去夏令营go__to__summer__camp(4)与某人一起去go__with__someone
(5)buy something special买特殊的东西
(6)遇见有趣的人meet__someone__interesting
(7)study for tests为考试学习
3.I can summarize.(我会总结)
Did you buy anything special?其中anything 是不定代词。
复合不定代词用法小结:
(1)带some的复合不定代词常用于肯定句中;带any的复合不定代词常用于否定句或疑问句中。
(2)当形容词修饰不定代词时,应放在其后面。
(3)复合不定代词作主语时,都作单数看待,其谓语动词用第三人称单数形式。
(1)I did somethinginteresting last summer.去年夏天我做了有趣的事情。
(2)Did you go anywherecool on vacation?假期你去凉爽的地方了吗?
(3)在那里我没见到人。 I didn’t see anyone there.
Task2Let\'slisten to the tape and finish 1b,2a,2b.
Task3Let\'smake conversations and interview.
1.I can practice.(我会练)
A:Grace,where did you go on vacation?
B:I went to (1)Central__Park(中央公园).
A:Oh,really?Did you go with anyone?
B:No.No__one(没有人)was here. Everyone wason vacation.
A:Did you buy (3)anything__special(特殊的东西)?
B:No.I bought nothing.
【导练】
( C )Did you see ______ in the dining room?
A.someoneB.some one
C.anyone D.anyone
八年级上册英语课件 篇6
What are you doing for vacation? 学习目标: 在这一单元中,我们要学习如何谈论假期的计划(Vacation plans),对将来的安排(Future plans) 语言目标: 1. 用现在进行时表示将来。 (Present progressive as future) 2. 用where , when , what , how long 提问的句子。 主要句型: 1. What are you doing for vacation ? I’m spending time with my friends . 2. When are you going ? I’m going next week . 3. How long are you staying ? We’re staying for two weeks . Step 1. National Day is coming . We all have a long vacation about 7 days . What are you doing for vacation ? Now Let’s talk about future plans . 在这里,我们用到What are you doing for vacation ? 同学们可能会奇怪,“be doing”结构不是现在进行时吗?在这一单元中,用现在进行时代表将要发生 的动作,表示对未来的计划和安排,译为“我将要…”,“我打算…”。 eg . What’s she doing for vacation ? 她假期要做什么? She’s babysitting her sister . 她要看她妹妹。 这是我们进入初中以来第一次接触到将来时。这种用现在进行时表示将来动作的用法,实际上在英语中 是很常见的。 Now , answer my question . “What are you doing for vacation ? ” You may have lots of answers . Now , translate the following sentences into English , and choose one as your answer . Of course , you can add more activities if you like . Exercise : 1. 我要去野营。 2. 我打算看望我的姨妈。 3. 我打算在家里看电视。 4. 她要照顾她的小妹妹。 5. 他打算玩篮球。 6. 他们要在家里休息。 7. 我要去山区徒步旅行。 8. Dave准备去骑单车。 9. Mary要去旅行观光。 10. Mike准备去钓鱼。 11. Isabella要去散散步并且租些录像来看。 Keys : 1. I’m going camping . 2. I’m visiting my aunt . 3. I’m watching TV at home . 4. She’s babysitting her sister . 5. He is playing basketball (for vacation). 6. They are relaxing at home . 7. I’m going hiking in the mountains . 8. Dave is going bike riding . 9. Mary is going sightseeing . 10. Mike is going fishing . 11. Isabella is taking walks and renting videos . Step 2 . We’re going to learn other questions to ask about one’s vacation plans . 除了用“What are you doing for vacation ? ”之外,我们还要学习其它几个问句,来帮助我们更好 地谈论假期的`计划。 1. When are you going ? 你什么时候去呀? when表示对具体的时刻来提问,所以可以用on Monday ,(在星期一),on the 12th (在12号那天) nextweek (下周)、等等。 eg. I’m going the first week in June . 我将在六月份的第一周去。 2. How long are you staying ? 你要在那里呆多久? How long 是对表示持续的一段时间来提问。因此回答时,也要用表示一段时间的时间状语,而不是具 体时刻。 eg. How long is he staying ? He’s staying for a week . 他要呆一个礼拜。 或He’s staying until September . 他在那里一直到九月份。 3. Where are you going for vacation ? 你要去哪里度假? I’m going to Italy (Greece or Spain ). 我要去意大利(希腊或西班牙)。 4. What’s it like there ? 那里怎么样? 这个句型是我们在第二册中学习过的,当时我们对人提问,“What’s she like ? ”她这人怎么样。 现在是对地点对问,请你介绍一下对某地的看法与印象。 你可以回答:It’s beautiful ! It’s wonderful ! 等等。 5. How’s the weather there ? 那里的天气怎么样? 这也是上学期我们学过的句子。你可以用一系列表示天气的词来回答。 如It’s cool . (hot , humit , warm …) 6. Who are you going with ? 你准备和谁一块儿去? I’m going with my parents . 我和我父母一块儿去。 学会了上面这些句子,我们又增加了许多谈话的内容。同学们在课外,可以勤练习。 Step 3. Section B. 3a P17 1. Read the article . After reading , answer my questions . Pierre Lambert’s Vacation Plans ! Pierre Lambert , the famous French singer , is taking a long vacation this summer ! He thought about going to Greece or Spain , but finally decided on Canada . “I always take vacations in Europe , ”he said . “This time I want to do something different . I heard that Canada is beautiful , and I know there are many people there who speak French . ” Pierre is going to Canada’s Great Lakes region . He is leaving the first week in June and staying until September . He plans to have a very relaxing vacation . “I’m taking walks , going fishing , and going bike riding . I’m hoping that the beautiful countryside will help me forget all my problems . At night , I’m renting videos and sleeping a lot …a no-stress vacation ! I can’t wait . I’ll be a new man when I return to Paris ! Questions : (1)Where is Pierre going for vacation ? (2)When is he going ? (3)Why did he decide on Canada ? (4)What is he doing there ? (5)How long is he staying ? Keys : (1)Pierre is going to Canada’s Great Lakes region . (2)He is going the first week in June . (3)It is beautiful and there are many people there who speak French . (4)He’s taking walks 、 going fishing 、 going bike riding . At night , he’s renting videos and sleeping a lot . (5)He is staying until September . 二. 重点、难点: 1. Pierre Lambert , the famous French singer , is taking a long vacation this summer . 著名法国歌星皮埃尔,在这个夏季,准备度个长假。 take a (long) vacation . 去度(长)假。 2. He thought about going to Greece or Spain , but finally decided on Canada . 他考虑要去希腊或西班牙,但最终决定去加拿大。 △think about (doing)sth . 考虑(去做)某事。 eg. He often thinks about going camping . 他经常考虑去野营。 △decide on 决定(后面加名词) eg. decide on a blue coat 决定(要买)一件蓝色上衣 decide on Canada 决定(去)加拿大 3. I want to do something different . 我想做一些不寻常的事。 something 为不定代词,另外还有anything , nothing , somebody , anyone 等,都是不定代词。当 有形容词修饰这些不定代词时,切记放在这些不定代词的后面。 eg. something different 不寻常的事 somebody important 重要人物 Is there anything wrong ? 有什么不对的吗? 4. I know there are many people (who speak French ) there . 我知道,那儿有许多人讲法语。 在本句中,出现了一个重要的语法现象,定语从句。“Who speak French ”做为定语从句修饰前面的 词组many people . 许多人,什么样的人呢?说法语的人。这样,我们就很好理解了。从前,我们学过, the beautiful flower , 这里beautiful 做为定语,修饰flower , 花,什么样的花?美丽的花。当单个 的词做定语,一般放在名词的前面,(注:修饰不定代词时需放在后边),而当一个句子做定语时,一般要 放在被修饰词的后面,这个句子则被称为定语从句。 eg . I’m waiting for that man (who is in black . ) 我正在等那个穿黑衣服的人。 5. Canada’s Great Lakes region . 加拿大的五大湖地区。(加拿大与美国之间的五个大湖, 景色怡人,风景秀丽。) 6. He plans to have a very relaxing vacation . △plan to do sth . 计划去做某事,to后面加动词原形。 eg. My classmates plan to go to a picnic . 我的同学们计划去野餐。 △have a very relaxing vacation . 过一个非常惬意的假期。 另外,have a good time 过得很愉快。 7. I’m hoping (that the beautiful countryside will help me forget all my problems . ) 我希望美丽的风光能帮我忘记一切烦恼。 △在本句中,that引导的一整句话,都做为谓语hope的宾语,被称为宾语从句。这一整句都是“我所希 望的事”。that只是宾语从句的引导词,没有实际含义。 eg. The teacher said that some students left school at 5:30 yesterday . 老师说,昨天有些同学五点半才离校。 help sb do sth . 帮助某人做某事。 在Unit 1 中,我们学过“help me to study more”这
最新七年级上册英语课件(锦集七篇)
每个老师上课需要准备的东西是教案课件,每个老师都要认真写教案课件。教案是教师进行教学设计与理论补充的有力工具,课件教案应该怎么做?挑选了一篇网络上非常出色的“七年级上册英语课件”文章分享给大家,希望本文能够为您提供可行的解决方案解决您的困扰!
七年级上册英语课件(篇1)
【设计思路】
本节课教授的词汇主要是服饰类的,课型属于听说课。所以在课前先营造一种轻松的学习氛围,教唱一首英语歌曲,让学生尽快地融入进课堂,期间还有pair work,groupwork,把学生分成两两小组或四人小组,互相对话。这样的活动要进行两次,可以提供给学生充分的时间进行交流。
【教材分析】
本节课是第七单元的第一课时,学生在前一单元初步学习完有关食物的英语知识之后,进一步地在本单元学习有关服饰的知识。而本课时是第一课时,所授的知识点应该浅显易懂,不应该太难。本课时围绕着几个关于服饰的词汇和两个询问价钱的句型展开。
词汇首当其冲,在学习词汇之后,句型的教授也应该把握重点,本课时的主要句型是How much is…? It’s … dollars. How much are …? They are …dollars. 词汇的重点是要区分单复数,还有dollar的用法。
【教学目标】
(一)教学知识点
(1) New words:T-shirt,sweater,bag,hat,skirt,socks,shorts,pants,shoes,
(2) Questions and answers:How much is/are…?It’s/They are…dollars.
(二)能力训练要求
(1) 通过师生对话,生生对话等一系列活动,提高学生实际运用英语的能力。
(2) 体会合作学习所带来的快乐。
(三)情感与价值观要求
通过学生互相帮助,互相学习,体验集体荣誉感和成就感,发展合作精神。
【教学重点和难点】
重点:
(1) 学会重点词汇的发音,单复数形式的掌握。
(2) 学会询问价钱的英语句型及其回答。
难点:
(1) 表示大小,颜色的形容词同时出现在名词前时,该如何摆放。
(2) 听力2a前,如何充分铺垫,以便于学生跟上录音速度。
【教学策略与手段】
(1) 师生对话,生生对话。
(2) 充分运用现代教育技术手段。
【学情分析】
两人或三人合作编一个在商店购物的对话
设计意图:让学生学以致用,因为语言是源于生活的,不是枯燥乏味一味用来考试的。
【板书设计】
bag /bAg/How much is the bag?It’s… dollars.hat /hAt/How much are the shorts?skirt/sk[:t/ They are…
dollars.sweater/5swet[/shirt/F[:t/shorts /FC:ts/pants/pAnts/ shoes/FU:z
上面内容就是一米范文范文为您整理出来的4篇《七年级上册英语课件》,能够给予您一定的参考与启发,是一米范文范文的价值所在。
七年级上册英语课件(篇2)
牛津初中英语知识点汇总
7
1. an instruction book
2. a secondary school
3. introduce sb. to
4. start school
5. greet your partner
6. be clever at
7. have one cousin
8. have black hair in a ponytail
9. wear glasses
10. football field/pitch
11. at the weekend
12. kick/score a goal
13. The more English you speak in class, the faster you will learn.
14. practise doing
15. dark brown
16. talk on the phone
17. a computer programmer
18. have breakfast/lunch/dinner
have a wonderful dinner
19. have fun doing sth.
20. keep a diary
21. do after-class activities
22. at lunch time
23. go to assembly
24. spend + 时间/钱 + on sth
in doing sth.
25. on a school day
26. too much + 不可数名词 much too + adj/adv
27. win the first prize
28. all the time
29. meet up with sb.
30. go on a school trip
31. look forward to a great day
32. look forward doing
33. have problems/trouble/difficulty with
34. have problems/trouble/difficulty doing
35. dress up as a ghost
36. celebrate Halloween in many ways
37. give us candies as a treat
38. play a trick on
39. cut out
40. make…out of…
41. at Christmas/On Christmas Day
42. on holiday
43. give sb.a hint
44. dream of/about doing
45. join an e-club
46. take turns to do
47. get tired
48. between meals
49. a top student
50. log onto the website
51. an online interview
52. Good luck with your report
53. keep fit and stay healthy
54. full of energy
55. take in
56. a shopping mall
57. There’s a discount on sth.
58. prefer to do rather than do
59. prefer doing to doing
60. They match her T-shirt.
61. wait for one’s turn
62. help with my homework
63. call sb.on 5551
64. They fit very well
65. a fun place to go
66. 10 more minutes = another 10 minutes
67. raise money for Project Hope
68. join in the fashion show
69. in the 20th century
70. in the 1970s/1970’s
71. an interesting talk on…
72. wear my hair in a 1990s style
73. have fun doing
74. end in “e”
75. go to/attend assembly
76. write sth in the correct order
77. cut sth. into the shape of
78. be made of
79. be tired out
80. invite sb.to do
七年级上册英语课件(篇3)
Ⅰ.教学准备
1.教师:录音机、磁带、图片、多媒体课件。
2.学生:准备一份班级的课程表;制作一份英语课程表。
Ⅱ.教学目标
1.知识目标:
(1)单词:favorite,subject,science,music,math,Chinese,geography,history
(2)句型:—What's your favorite subject?—My favorite subject is art.
2.能力目标:通过本课学习,掌握一些词汇、句型等语言知识,能够运用所学词汇、句型和他人交流,提高英语口语表达能力。
3.情感目标:通过互相谈论喜欢的学科,增进同学之间的了解和友情。
4.文化意识:了解英语国家学生的学习生活,增强跨文化交际的意识。
Ⅲ.教学重点
1.单词:favorite,subject,science,geography,history
2.句型:—What's your favorite subject?—My favorite subject is science.
Ⅳ.教学难点
1.熟练运用所学的词汇、句型表达和交流信息。
2.正确运用本课中所学的表示品质的形容词描述事物。
Ⅴ.教学步骤
Step 1:Leadin
建议1:教师播放各学科上课的画面,问学生分别是什么学科,引出各学科的名称,最后做一个总结。
For example:
T:Class!Please look at the picture.What subject is it?
S1:It's Chinese.
S2:It's math.
S3:It's geography.
S4:It's science.
Then the teacher has a summary:Chinese,m ath,geography,science...
建议2:教师问学生现在学习的学科有哪些,让学生列举出来,从而引出各学科的名称,最后总结一下。
For example:
T:Class!How many subjects are you learning now?What subjects are they?
S1:We are learning Chinese,math,English...
S2:And science,music,history...
Then call some other students to have a sup plement.In the end,let the the students give a summary.
建议3:教师问学生现在学的科目有哪些,找一两个学生来回答。然后教师 和学生做一个看图猜谜游戏。让学生看图,猜猜是什 么学科,最后让学生将各学科全部总结一下。
For example:
T:Class!What subjects are you learning now?Can you say out?
S1:Chinese,math,English...
S2:P.E...history...
T:Class!Please look at each picture.What subject is it?Can you gue ss?
Let the students look and guess.In the end,let the students have a summary.
Step 2:Present ation
建议:教师引导学生将1a中的各学科名称与图画进行配对。
For example:
T:Class!Look at 1a and the pictures.Can you match the words with the right picture?
Call one or two individuals to check the answers.
Step 3:Practice
建议1:教师问学生是否能准确流利地读出1a中的单词,找几名学生朗读一遍。对于读错的单词,教师纠正其发音错误,并领读两遍。然后让全班同学齐读两遍。
For example:
T:Class!Can you read the words in 1a correctly?
Then call some individuals to read.
S1:P.E.,art,science,music,math,Chinese,geography,history.
S2:P.E.,art,science,music,math,Chinese,geography,history.
Then the teacher corrects their pronunciation mistakes,and then has a leading reading.
In the end,let all the students read the words collectively.
建议2:教师领读两遍,然后将全班同学分成三组或四组,组织一次朗读比赛,看哪一组读得好。最后进行一个看图抢答游戏,看谁说得又对又快,奖励说得又对又快的学生。
For example:
T:Class!Let's practice readi ng the words.Please read the words after me.
Then the teacher has a leading reading.The students follow the teacher.
T:Class!Now,let's play a guessing game.Look at the pictures and rush to say out the subjects.Award the students who said correctly and quickly.
Step 4:Leadin
建议:教师问学生是否能熟练说出1a中的单词,告诉学生将进行一次听力测验,以检验学生是否完全掌握1a中的单词。
For example:
T:Class!Have you grasped the words of the subjects in 1a?Now let's have a test.
Then let the students listen to the conversations in 1b.
Step 5:Consolidation
建议:教师将听力原文投放在屏幕上,把重点单词去掉。让学生再听一遍录音,填出单词,补全对话。
For example:
T:Class!Look at the listening text.Listen to the tape again,write out the missing words.
After listening,call one or two individuals to check the answers.See how well they did.
Step 6:Practice
建议1:教师让学生大声读一遍听力原文,问学生是否有不理解的地方。如果有,教师给予点拨讲解。
For example:
T:Class!Please read the listening text aloud.
Then let the students read for some time.
T:Class!Do you have anything that you don't understand?
If they have,have a brief explanation.
建议2:让学生熟读几遍1b中的对话,找几名学生朗读对话,看看读得怎么样。教师给予语音、语调、语气等方面的指导和纠正。然后将全班学生分成两大组,练习对话,看看哪一组说得好。
For example:
T:Class!Please read the conversations aloud by yourselves.Then I'll ask some of you to read.
After reading,the teacher corrects th e mistakes about their pronunciation.And tell the students what tones and intonations they should use.
T:Class!Let's practice the conversations between groups.See which group will say better.
Group A:What's your favorite subject?
Group B:My favorite subject is...
Group A:Why do you like...?
Group B:Because it's...
建议3:教师让学生自己熟读几遍对话,然后让学生两人合作表演对话。
For example:
T:Class!First,please read the conversations aloud by yourselves.Next,please practice performing the conversations in pairs.Then I'll call some of you to act out.
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S2:My favorite subject is...
S1:Why do you like...?
S2:Because it's...
Step 7:Leadin
建议:由步骤6谈论的内容自然过渡到问学生最喜欢什么学科以及喜欢的原因。
For example:
T:Class!Just now we talked about some people's favorite subjects.
What about you?What's your favorite subject?Can you talk about it?
S1:My favorite subject is...
T:Why do you like...?
S1:Because it's...
Then call some individuals to practice with the teacher in the same way.
Step 8:Practice
建议1:通过步骤7的导入,引出要练习的句型。让学生两人合作编对话,并进行表演。比一比哪一组说得好。
For example:
T:Class!Can you make a similar dialogue in pairs?Then I'll call some of you to act out.
Then let the students work in pairs to make a dialogue.
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S2:My favorite subject is...
S1:Why do you like...?
S2:Because it's...
建议2:做一个“找朋友”的游戏。让学生在班内走动,互相询问喜欢什么学科,找到与自己喜欢的科目相同的人。
For example:
T:Class!Let's play a game—Find friends who likes the same subject with you!
You can leave your seats and go around the class.Ask everyone what his/her favorite subject is.The one who likes the same subject with you is just your friend.
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S2:My favorite subject is...
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S3:My favorite subject is...
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S4:My favorite subject is...
Step 9:Consolidation
建议:教师让学生做个陈述报告,陈述自己喜欢什么学科以及喜欢的理由。
For example:
T:Class!Now let's have a report about your favorite subject and the reason why you like it.You can report like following:
Hello!Everyone!My name is...I like some subjects,such as...But my favorite subject is...Because it's...
Let the students pra ctice it for some time.Then call some students to act out.
Step 10:Task
建议:教师让学生在小组内做采访调查。询问组内每个成员喜欢什么学科以及喜欢的原因。然后找几组同学进行采访表演。
For example:
T:Class!Now in your group,have an interview and make a survey.Ask the members of your group what their favorite subjects are,and the reasons why they like them.
Then call some groups to perform their interview.
S1:Hello!I'm a reporter.Can I ask you some questions?
S2:Yes.
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S2:My favorite subject is...
S1:Why do you like...?
S2:Because it's...
Step 11:Summary
建议:教师让学生自己总结本节课所学的内容,包括单词和句型。
For example:
T:Class!Let's sum up what we have learned in this class.What words did we learn?
Ss:Favorite,subject,science,music,math,Chinese,geography,history.
T:What sentences did we learn?
Ss:What's your favorite subject?My favorite subject is art.
Step 12:Homework
1.和你的同伴讨论各自喜欢什么学科以及喜欢的原因,编成对话并表演。
对话模式:
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S2:My favorite subject is...
S1:Why do you like...?
S2:Because it's...
2.调查你周围的同学,问问他们喜欢什么学科。作好记录,制成表格。
Names Favorite subjects
板书设计
Unit 9 My favorite subject is science.
Section A 1a1c
Words Sentences
favorite,subject,science,music,math,Chinese,geography,history —What's your favorite subject?
—My favori te subject is science.
备课资料
知识讲解
1.表示学科的名词,有几个单词首字母要大写,因为它们是专有名词。例如:Chinese,English,P.E.
2.—What's your favorite subject?
—My favorite subject is art.
favorite表示“最喜欢的”。
—What's your favorite sport?—My favorite sp ort is basketball.
—What's your favorite food?—My favorite food is hamburger.
3. What's your favorite subject?(同义句)
→What subject do you like best?
My favorite subject is art.(同义句)
→ I like art best.
七年级上册英语课件(篇4)
Unit 5
一 、教学目标
(一)语言知识
语音 /t/ /d/ /ts/ /dz/ /tr/ /dr/ /l/ /m/ /n/
词汇 掌握wake,early,first,day,term,must,still,by,on foot,the same to,usually,always,Ms.,boat,ship,sea,train,by plane/air/airplane, etc.
理解 Subway Worm reporter,Net Bar,roller skating Measure dining hall,dormitory bookstore,etc.
(二)语法
1.一般现在时(Simple present)
2.频度副词(Adverbs of frequency)never, seldom, sometimes, often, usually, always, once, twice
3.现在进行时(Present continuous)
I’m looking for a book.
Are you doing your homework?Yes, I am./No, Im not.
Is he/she...?Yes, he/she is./No, he/she isn’t.
What are you doing now?I’m playing computer games.
What is he/she doing?He/She is...
4.谈论交通方式(Talking about means of transport)
How do you usually go to school? I usually go to school by bike.
(三)功能用语与话题
1.采访(Interviews)Our guest today is Michael from Class 2, Grade 1.
2.谈论日常生活(Talking about routines)
3.学校建筑(School buildings)swimming pool, playground, library, dormitory, lab, canteen, gym
4.谈论兴趣喜好(Talking about interests, likes and dislikes)I like the swimming pool best. Why do you like English? Because it’s interesting and easy.
5.借物(Borrowing things)How long can I keep it? Two weeks.
6.新闻(News)、海报(Poster)Attention, please! Here is the news.
7.谈论学校活动、科目和时间表(Talking about school activities, subjects and timetable)
8.谈论学校生活(Talking about school life)
(四)能力培养
听 能听懂谈论校园生活中比较熟悉的话题,识别主题,获取主要信息。
说 1能根据提示词说出意思连贯的校园生活的句子。
2能用简单对话描述校园生活。
3能根据图片或借助他人帮助描述自己或他人的校园生活。
4能与他人合作进行角色扮演,表现校园生活。
读 1能理解简单的书面表达。
2能准确地朗读课文。
3能读懂表现校园生活方面的.文章,包括校园新闻、海报、遗失声明、失物招领等。
写 能写出表现校园生活方面的简单句子。能写出简单的校园新闻、海报、遗失声明、失物招领等。
情感态度 培养学生积极向上的情感、活泼开朗的个性、浓厚的学习兴趣和大胆实践的精神,提高学习效率,培养学生热爱学校生活,乐于学校生活的意识。
学习策略 积极探索适合自己的英语学习方法,利用现实生活中的学习资源,培养任务型学习方法与技巧。
二、教材分析
本单元的交际用语主要是围绕学生的学校生活展开的,谈论学生的上学方式、作息时间、课程安排、业余生活等内容,这些内容为学生所熟悉,便于展开讨论。
本单元的语法内容主要是学习一般现在时、现在进行时以及表示频度的副词。
Topic 1
Section A
教学目标:
1.谈论交通工具及如何上学。
2.学习句型:How do you usually come to school?
I usually come to school by subway.
本课重点1a和3a。难点:谈论交通工具及如何上学。
教具 录音机
五指教学方案
课时建议:1~2
教学过程:
第一步:复习
1.教学生如何在开学的第一天相互问候。
T: Good morning, class! S: Good morning, Miss.../Mr...
T: Nice to see you again! S: Nice to see you, too.
学习问候语:
T: Happy New Year! S: The same to you.
然后老师说:Boys and is the first day of our new term.
解释today, new term。
老师说:I often come to school by bus. My son often takes the subway to school. What about you?
学习词组by bus, take the subway。
Notes: subway(AmE)=underground(BrE)
2. 听录音3a,回答问题:
(1)How does Kangkang usually come to school?
(2)How does Sally always come to school?
两人一组作对话,然后请3~4对同学到前面表演对话。(对参加表演的同学给予鼓励。)完成3b。
第二步:呈现
1.老师向一些同学依次展示并学习词组:wake up, get up, go to school, by bike等,然后做动作练习。要一名同学在前作动作,其余同学猜测词组。
2.听录音1,回答问题:
What’s the time? / Is it time to get up?
Who wakes Kangkang up? 完成1。
3.利用图画,完成2。
4.听录音4,完成4。
第三步:巩固
1.放录音1和3a,学生跟读。
2.学生两人一组表演1和3a。
第四步:练习
1.分组活动,谈论自己早晨的活动情况。
2.双人活动,分别用不同的交通工具图片进行问答:
A:How do you usually come to school?
B:I usually come to school...
例如:on foot, by bike, by bus, by car, by train, by subway, by boat/ship, by plane/air,完成4。
3.让学生做一个调查报告,调查全班同学“How do you usually go to school?”按人数从多到少列成表格,向大家汇报:
In our class, fifteen students go to school by bike...完成5。
第五步:综合探究活动
1.学生以表格的形式展示自己的家人通常所采用的交通方式。
2.请同学据自己所了解的情况,介绍其它中学生早晨的活动情况,如:
“In our class, some students usually wake up at 6∶30. They get up at 6∶35...”
七年级上册英语课件(篇5)
Review the second part of 6B, from Unit 5 to Unit 7, check their controlling of the vocabularies, structures and the daily talks.
Unit 5: Control the words about weather, and the structures about how to ask weather: What’s the weather like…? Which season do you like best? ect.
Unit 6: Control the words about planning, and know how to plan for the weekend. Control the structures about calling sb., and how to ask plans: What are you going to do ?
Unit 7: Control the words about letters, and the structures about how to write a letter. Control the daily talk:What should I do? I want to do ….
Emotions: Train their ability to use all of the points together, and make a conversation or short dialogue.
Help them to take more interesting in it.
Teaching plans: four lessons
Part C Part B
Part B、D、A Test
The First Period
教学目标:
ntrol all the phrases in this unit, and can use the structures to practice: What are you going to do this afternoon? I’m going to … with my friends. Would you like to join us? Yes I’d love to. // No. I’m going to …
2.Train their ability to use the structures and phrases to describe their plans
教学重、难点:
Correct pronunciation and using of the phrases and structures
教学准备:tape, cards
教学环节:
Step 1 Free talk
Review the next used structures
Do the free talk with all the students. Then review the structures: What are you going to do? I’m going to…
Ss answer the question with the learned verb phrases. I’m going to have a picnic. I’m going to see a play. I’m going to …
Step 2 Presentation
Learn new phrases and review the learned
Give them a range: In the countryside(let Ss think about the verb phrases can do in the countryside) then teacher adds, Plant trees, water flowers, mike cows .Go fishing ect. Do the same way to teach the other phrases
Ss think out the phrases: Pick apples, grow flowers, Fly kites, ect.
Step 3 Practice
Check their controlling of these phrases
Practice the structures with these phrases
Ss practice in a group of four, then act it out
Step 4 Reading
Check the pronunciation
Teacher reads the phrases for the first time, and asks Ss to follow and spell them.
Ss do this job follow the teacher
Step 5 Homework
Write four short dialogues, and two for agree, two for disagree
The second period
教学目标:
1.Review the words about weather. Learn to describe the four seasons.
2.Review the structures of unit 5.
3.Help them to make short dialogue about how to describe seasons
教学重、难点
Correct describe ration for the weather in different season
教学准备:tape, card, pictures
教学环节
Step 1 Free talk
1.Check their Vocabularies
2.Teacher asks some questions about the weather: What’s the weather like in spring?
( summer, autumn, winter)
3.Ss find the words to describe the weather of spring
4.Ss give the answers to another seasons.
Step 2 Practice
Train their ability to make dialogue
Ask Ss to make a short dialogue about the weather of four seasons.
Then ask them to say it in a short context.They discuss in a group, and then act it out.
Then ask one to conclude
Step 3 Writing
Controlling of the words
Ask them to finish the exercise of page 65, “the four seasons”Then read follow the tape one by one, control the correct pronunciation
Ss first finish the passages, then repeat follow the tape , got the correct pronunciation
Step 4 Explanation
Got the important grammar
Teacher explains the difficult points in the passage, then give some more examples.
get warmer get green in rivers and lakes go skating go skiing
Ss got the pronunciation and got the important points
Step 5 Homework
read the passage five times after class
recite tomorrow
The Third Period
教学目标
1.Review the structure about how to make pen friends
2.Review the asking way about the name, city , age, telephone number, fax number, e-mail address, school, favorite subject ect. Help them to make a short passage to describe their pen friend
教学重、难点
The correct asking way of these information questions.
教学准备:tape, cards
教学环节
Step 1 Free talk
Check their oral English
Teacher first greets to all the students, and then ask some questions about their information, such as: How old are you? Where do you live? What’s your telephone number? Do you have a brother or a sister? sect.
Ss first do the morning greeting together, and then answer the questions about their own information.
Step 2 Practice
Check their correct answering of the questions
Let them ask questions to their partner about his/her best friend’s information, and then finish the notes on page 69.Then tell the passage
Ss practice and finish all the questions, and try to introduce their best friend to all the classmates.
Step 3 Reading
Check their reading ability and learn to write a passage
Give them the example of how to introduce one person.
Show the passage, and play the tape, let them listen and read.Then follow it, and try to repeat
Read; learn the way of writing, and then repeat follow the tape
Try to write a passage with other two pictures.
Step 4 Home work
Write a passage about the introduction of their best friend.
Finish the exercise book.
The Fourth Period
完成本单元测试。
七年级上册英语课件(篇6)
一、教材分析
本教材前面四个模块为复习模块,总结了小学阶段教材中出现过的语言知识,以帮助同学们有效地从小学到初中有一个平缓的过渡。所以这四个模块不必花大量时间来学习,每个模块用4节课来讲解、复习就可以了,四个模块共用16节课。接下来是10个学习模块和两个复习模块,每个学习模块共有三个单元,前面两个单元主要为大家呈现新的语言内容,第三单元为练习与活动,用以巩固前面两个单元所学的内容。本学期一共18周,每周6节课,共108节课。去掉前面16节课复习小学知识,还有92节课,所以每个学习模块需要7节课来学习与巩固。还剩8节课用于每个月的月考。
二、教学目标
本套教材同时配有对应的网络教材。上课时可利用此网络教材教学。
通过对本教材的学习,希望同学们能够:
1)形成对英语学习的积极态度和强烈兴趣。
2)掌握基本的英语知识和听说读写技能,提升英语语言的运用能力。
3)形成有效的英语学习策略。
4)增强对世界文化的了解,培养自己的跨文化交流意识。
三、 教学对象分析
本学期初中部有两个班级,初一级和初二级。
其中初一级共有26位同学,对于学习的积极性比较高,但其中有11位同学基础比较差,可以说没有基础。针对这11位同学,需要帮他们把音标补上。通过音标,他们能够把单词读出来,然后才能把单词记下来,如果他们自己不放弃,加把劲,慢慢地单词积累多了,多读、多听,语感培养起来了,他们就能够跟上。每天晚上
花半个小时来读课文和读单词,每天听写10个单词,然后借助遗忘规律来复习,达到对单词深层的记忆。为了让成绩好的同学有所发挥,成绩弱的同学有所思考,听写完十个单词之后,每个单词自己造句,提高英语的思维能力和运用能力。
初二级共有29位同学,其中有十几位同学没有基础,需要学习音标,然后多读,多记单词、课文。由于初二班孩子年纪比较长,对于学习的自主能力比较强,只要调动他们学习的积极性,让他们自己明确学习的目的,很快就能够跟上。
四、教学方法
子学的孩子,学习文化课,获得高分只是其中一个次要的目的。更重要的,我们要通过文化课来提升自身的素养,与社会接轨,以后能够更好地服务于社会。所以不建议采取题海战术,况且我们也没有过多的时间来进行题海战术。
1)首先,打基础。把本册里的单词全部记下来,每天晚上花半个小时记单词、短语,读课文。(根据遗忘规律:背完单词之后的5分钟,20分钟,1小时,12小时,1天,2天,5天,8天,14天是复习的`时间点,在这些时间点复习背过的内容,14天后就能够达到深层的记忆,这也适用于其他科目的背诵。)
2)培养语感与兴趣,了解国外的生活习惯与文化。每周尽量给孩子看一部有意义,正能量的英文电影。
3)培养说英文的能力。学习英文歌曲《Wearetheworld》。
五、 教学反思
由于学生的个体差异,学生们完成课间任务的速度与效率不尽相同,一部分同学完成任务较快,于是思想开小差,或是讲小话。因此布置任务时,可根据学生的能力大小,给学生布置不同层次的任务。任务完成得较快的学生可对他们增设附加的任务。如会模仿――会背诵――会默写,层层拔高。每一堂课下来,每个学生根据自己的能力学到不同的知识。也可以让学习成绩好的同学翻译有趣的英文故事或者笑话,让他们生动形象的讲给全班同学听,既培养了优秀同学的能力,也增加了课堂的趣味性。
在今后的备课过程中,应多从学生的角度考虑,努力调整教学方式,大胆取舍教学内容,力求尊重学生个体差异,因材施教,让每个学生在学习英语的过程中都能感受到成功的喜悦,从而形成学习英语的浓厚兴趣,形成积极的学习态度。
七年级上册英语课件(篇7)
教学目标:
1、用 “Whose is this?”“It’s”询问及表达事物的归属。
2、“Whose is this?” “It’s” Yes, it is/No, it isn’t, it is
3、掌握词汇:bag, key, wallet, scarf, hat, mobile phone
4、理解词汇:whose
5、字母Uu在单词中的发音。
教学重、难点:
1、用 “Whose is this?”“It’s”询问及表达事物的归属。
2、教学难点: “Whose is this?” “It’s” Yes, it is/No, it is
课时安排: A部分 1课时 B、C、D部分 1课时 E、F、G部分 1课时
Period 1
一、教学目标
1、能听懂、会说新单词;
2、能听懂、会说本课对话;
3、能灵活运用句型询问物品的主人,及对此询问作出回应。
二、教学重点及难点
重点:熟练地使用句型询问物品的主人,替失物找到主人。
难点:掌握Benny’s, your, my的用法。
三、教学准备
大纸箱一只、一些物品或玩具、单词卡片、教学挂图、教学磁带等。
四、教学步骤
Step 1 Warming up
1、师生问候
2、自由会话和角色表演。
Step 2 Presentation and drill
1、在课前向学生借一些学习用品、玩具等,上课时放在讲台上一一出示,问是谁的东西。
T: Can you borrow me some pencils, pens and rulers? Thanks. What is this?
S1: It is a pencil.
T: Right. It’s a pencil. Whose is this? I am sorry. I forget it. Is this your pencil, S2? S2: No.
T: Is this your pencil, S3? S3: Yes. T: Oh, It is your pencil. It is S3’s pencil.
2、出示人物(Miss Li, Lingling, Jane, Jake, Peter, Mingming, Anne)的头饰及一些物品。 T: Who are they? Ss: They are T: Look! What are these? 帮助学生问答。板书单词a wallet, a bag, a scarf, 并带读。
T: Whose wallet is this? Can you guess? Is this Lingling’s wallet? S1: It’s Lingling’s wallet. S2: It’s Jane’s wallet.
T: I don’t know. Let’s look at the story.
3、出示课文A部分教学挂图(或多媒体课件)。听录音,复述所听到的内容。
4、听录音,跟读。
5、分组练习。
Step 3 Practice
游戏——Guess, guess, guess!(猜一猜)
让学生将自己的物品放入盒中,写上自己的名字。然后大家一起猜一猜该物品的主人是谁。
T: This is a book. Whose is this? S1: Is it Lily’s book? T: No. S2: Is it Peter’s book?
T: Yes, it is Peter’s book. Here you are, Peter. Peter: Thank you.
自由组合练习会话,让练习得熟练的学生分角色表演课文A部分。
Step 4 Consolidation
1、创设情景,自由对话。
情景:出示一些无人认领的物品,让学生们想办法找到它们的主人。尽量使用今天所学的句型“What is this?”“Whose is this?”“Is this?”“It is”。
2、评价。
3、家庭作业。听磁带,背课文。
Period 2
一、教学目标 :
能掌握新单词; 能熟练地运用句型询问物品的归属,及对此询问作出回应; 能阅读理解课文D部分小故事。
教学重点:
能听懂、会读、会说新单词。 难点:Anne’s的意思。
教学准备 :
一只大纸箱、实物、单词卡片、教学磁带等。
教学步骤
Step 1 Warming up
1、师生问候。
2、唱英语歌曲“If you’re happy and you know it.”。
Step 2 Presentation and drill 1、出示大纸箱。
T: Boys and girls, what is this? Ss: It is a box.
T: Right. It’s a magic box. Can you guess what is in it? Ss: A bird. /A pencil. /
T: Look, there is a bag in the magic box. It’s my bag. Do you have a bag? Ss: Yes.
T: What is in your bag? S1: A pencil-box.
T: What is in your pencil-box? S2: A pen/ pencil/ An eraser/ 2、T: What’s in my bag? Can you guess?
鼓励学生们使用自己学的单词大胆地猜测。然后打开提包,让大家看看其中的物品:a wallet, a bag, a scarf, a pen, glasses, a hat, a mobile phone.一边往外拿,一边说出其英语名称,并让学生跟读单词。同时板书单词。(每一件物品都放在前一件物品之内。为了增强趣味性,可以继续让学生们猜。) T: Do you have a wallet/bag/scarf/? Ss: Yes. /No.
T: What is in your wallet/
3、听课文B部分录音,跟读。
Step 3 Practice
游戏——Golden finger(金手指)
男女学生各一名参与游戏。教师说出某物品的名称,学生必须快速指到该物品。动物快的一方胜出,可得到一枚徽章作为奖励。
游戏—— Magic eyes(火眼金睛)
将某物品放入大纸箱中,让学生们猜一猜其中有什么东西。 T: Golden eyes, golden eyes, who has golden eyes? S1: I have golden eyes.
T: Can you guess what is in the magic box? S1: A bag? S1: A wallet? S1: A scarf?
T: Sorry, I don’t know. Please touch it and tell us the answer. S1: Oh! It’s a scarf.
听课文C部分录音。分组进行练习。 游戏——Dragon game(接龙游戏) S1: Whose is this, S2?
S2: It’s S3’s wallet. Whose is this, S3? S3: It’s S4’s bag. Whose is this, S4? S4:
Step 4 Consolidation
1、课文D部分。
1)听录音,看课文,理解故事大意。教师解释说明难点。
2)听录音,有感情地跟读。
3)分角色表演。
2、创设情景,自由会话。
情景:每个学生准备一些日用品,用已学的知识进行会话。
3、评价。对学生的描述和表演进行评价,给予鼓励和奖励。
4、练习。
Period 3
一、教学目标
1、能掌握字母Uu在单词中的发音,能理解新单词;
2、能理解、会读由含有字母Uu的单词组成的句子;
3、能掌握本课重点单词的书写;
4、完成课文E、G部分。在游戏中帮助学生掌握所学单词。
二、教学重点及难点
重点:字母Uu在单词中的发音;童谣的诵读。 难点:理解新单词,朗读句子。
三、教学准备
四线三格小黑板、教学磁带、单词卡片等。
四、教学步骤
Step 1 Warming up
1、师生问候。
2、复习单词。
游戏——Guess, guess, guess!(猜一猜) 教师轻声单词,学生猜。
游戏——Golden finger(金手指) 游戏——Quick response(快速反应)
Step 2 Presentation and drill
1、出示课文E部分单词图片。
2、听课文F部分的单词和句子,跟读。理解句子。可进行读句子比赛。
3、归纳字母Uu的发音,提醒学生注意发音时的口型。
4、示范单词的书写,让学生们练习。教师个别检查和辅导。
Step 3 Practice
游戏——Gross the bridge (过河)
设置一条河流,河流中有几块石头,每块石头上都有一个单词。一名学生认读单词,其他学生进行判断。当他能准确地读出单词时,同学齐说:“Yes, yes, yes! Go! Go! GO!”错了就说:“NO, no, no! Out! Out! Out!”全部读完后, 进行“绕口令”比赛。
1、创设情景。自由会话。 情景:设计一个失物招领台,自编对话,进行表演。
2、评价。
3、练习。
4、家庭作业。抄写单词、听录音。
八年级英语下册课件
以下是幼儿教师教育网小编整理的“八年级英语下册课件”类希望对大家有所帮助。教案课件是老师在课堂上非常重要的课件,因此就需要我们老师写好属于自己教学课件。教师的成功备课离不开完备的教案。如果您觉得这篇文章有参考价值请别忘了把这篇文章收藏下来!
八年级英语下册课件【篇1】
When you play things, you must get good corporation with your players.
教学重点、难点:
1、I am throwing the basketball.
教具、学具:
some balls and story a tape and pictures
Review “ past tense” and “ future tense” verbs with a game. Write three columns of words on the blackboard and ask for volunteers to match them correctly. As each student makes a match, he or she says “Yesterday IXXXde. Today IXXX. Tomorrow I am going toXX.
Add “buy” “teach” and “think” to your “today” column. Ask the students to give you the future tense for each verb and write them under your “tomorrow” column. Then write “taught” “thought” “bought” in a different order than the other two columns, and ask the students to guess how they match with the present-tense verbs. Point out the similarities in spelling “bought” “taught” “thought”
Pause after Number 1 in the student book. Review the story so far. Today Jenny and Li Ming went to the store buy some clothes for Li Ming to the pictures in the student book. Who are they talking to
Note the word “player” in the lesson. A “players” plays something, such as a sport.
Play “What’s wrong” to practice the new past tense verbs, and other tenses and verbs.
Play “spelling Bee” to practice spelling any vocabulary in this unit.
Tech “Oh, what did you do” in Number 3 of the student book.
Number 2 in the activity book is a listening exercise. The students listen to each sentence on the audiotape and change it into the past—tense. Here’s how the audiotape goes:
八年级英语下册课件【篇2】
教案:
教学主题:第二单元英语第二课
教学目标:
1. 学会问候语,如 Hello 和 Good morning/afternoon/evening 等。
2. 学会介绍自己,如 My name is \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_. I am \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_ years old. I am \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_. I am from \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_.
3. 学会表达感激之情,如 Thank you 和 Thank you very much 等。
4. 学会描述外貌,如 What is your \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_? How are you?
5. 学会表达喜好,如 What is your favorite \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_? Do you like \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_?
6. 学会表达意见,如 What do you think of \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_? How about \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_?
教学准备:
1. 教材:英语教材
2. 教学资源:图片、视频、音频等
3. 教学工具:黑板、粉笔、教鞭等
4. 教学评估:考试、作业、口头表达等
教学步骤:
1. 引入:通过图片、视频等引入本单元的主题,并简单介绍本课的内容。
2. 知识讲解:通过黑板、PPT等向学生讲解本单元的知识点,并举例说明。
3. 练习巩固:通过练习、作业等方式巩固本单元的知识点,并帮助学生提高听说读写的能力。
4. 小组活动:通过小组讨论、角色扮演等活动,激发学生的学习兴趣,并提高学生的团队合作能力。
5. 总结回顾:总结本单元的知识点,回顾本课的内容,并提醒学生巩固本单元的知识。
教学反思:
本单元的教学旨在帮助学生掌握问候语、介绍自己、表达感激之情、描述外貌、表达喜好和表达意见等知识点,并提高学生的听说读写能力。在教学过程中,我注重了与学生的互动,通过小组活动和提问等方式,激发学生的学习兴趣,并提高了学生的学习效果。在练习巩固的过程中,我注重了学生的反馈,及时纠正学生的错误,并提醒学生巩固本单元的知识。在总结回顾的过程中,我总结了本单元的知识点,并提醒学生巩固本单元的知识。总的来说,本单元的教学效果较好,但也存在一些问题,如部分学生对于问候语的理解和表达能力较差,需要加强练习。
八年级英语下册课件【篇3】
教学目标
一、知识与技能
1. 掌握常用动词的过去分词的拼写形式以及熟练掌握already,yet在现在完成时中的应用。
2. 体会现在完成时在阅读文章《鲁滨逊漂流记》中的应用以及对阅读文章的理解分析。
3. 熟练掌握 already,yet 在现在完成时中的用法。
4. 掌握常用动词的过去分词形式。
5. 使用阅读技巧对阅读文章进行理解与分析。
二、过程与方法
将抽象知识具体化,帮助学生总结规律,系统地学习语法。调动学生的积极性,引导他们积极参与课堂。
三、情感态度与价值观
通过对《鲁宾逊漂流记》节选部分的学习,引导学生在生活和学习中要不抛弃不放弃。
教学重点
1. 体会现在完成时在阅读文章《鲁滨逊漂流记》中的应用以及对阅读文章的理解分析。
2. 熟练掌握already,yet在现在完成时中的用法。
教学难点
1. 使用阅读技巧对阅读文章进行理解与分析。
2. 熟练掌握already,yet在现在完成时中的用法。
教法导航
通过大量练习让学生主动掌握语法知识。
学法导航
练习、讨论、主动探求规律。
教学准备
多媒体。
教学过程
Step 1 Greetings
Greet the students as usual.
Step 2 Presentation
Introduce the movie:Robinson Crusoe.
The teacher shows some introductions on the screen to arouse the students’ interests.
Step 3 Learn the new words
ship,tool,gun,sand,else,cannibal,towards,land.
Step 4 Reading
3a, Read the passage and answer the following questions:
What does Robinson Crusoe wait for?
Why does Robinson Crusoe call the man Friday?
3b, Read the passage again. Find words that have these meanings.
1. You can use these to shoot things: _____
2. Something you use to travel in the sea: _____
3. A piece of land in the middle of the sea: ______
4. You can use these to cut things: ______
5. Signs left behind by someone or something: ______
3c, Correct the sentences:
1. Robinson Crusoe arrived on the island with enough food and drink.
2. Friday made a small boat.
3. Robinson had some food and tools when he first arrived on the island.
4. Robinson used the ship to build a house.
5. Friday saw some marks of another man’s feet on the beach.
6. Robinson tried to kill the two men.
After they finished the questions and let them check the answers.
Then get them read aloud the passage again and the teacher helps deal with the difficult points.
1) I will not give up and I will wait for another ship. 因此我不放弃,要等候另一只船。
another 既可用作形容词,也可用作代词。用作形容词时,意思是“又一的;再一的”,修饰名词,位于名词前;用作代词时,意思是“另一个”。
e.g. Just at that time,another man came in.
Saying is one thing and doing is another.
another还可以和数词连用,常放在数词的前面,意为“还;再;又”。
e.g. We need another three man to help do the work.
2) Not long after that,I saw some cannibals trying to kill two men from a broken ship.
在那之后不久,我看见一些食人肉质在试图杀死两个来自破船上的人。
see sb. doing sth.意为“看到某人正在做某事”,强调看到的动作正在进行。
e.g. Mary saw him cleaning the classroom.
玛丽看见他正在打扫教室。
see sb. do sth. 意为“看到某人做了某事”,强调看到动作的全过程。
e.g. Mary saw him clean the classroom.
玛丽看见他打扫教室了。
3) I named him Friday because that was the day I met him.
我管他叫Friday因为那是我遇见他的那一天。
name作动词,意为“命名;给…取名”。固定搭配“name + sb. + 名字”意为“给某人取名为…”。
e.g. Lucy named her little son David. 露西给她的小儿子取名为戴维。
Step 5 Grammar Focus
Read the following sentences (让学生体会现在完成时的用法)。
师生共同总结出下列内容:
1.表示过去发生或已经完成的某一动作对现在造成的影响或结果。
e.g. ---Have you had your lunch yet?
---Yes,I have. I’ve just had it. (现在我不饿了)
2. 表示动作或状态从过去某一时刻开始,一直延续到现在,而且可能还要继续下去。
e.g. I haven’t seen her these days.
I’ve known Bob for three years.
I’ve been at this school for over two years.
时间状语 already,yet,just,ever,never,before;for + 时间段;since + 过去的时间点;since + 段时间 ago;since + 一般过去时的句子。
构成:现在完成时是由“助动词have /has+ 动词的过去分词”构成的,规则动词的过去分词构成与过去式相同,不规则动词的过去分词则需逐个记忆。
Step 6 Practice
Exercises
1. go through the tasks in 4a and 4b,then finish 4a and check the answers.
Keys:I have just drunk some tea.
Have you found it?
He has already left.
did he leave?
She has already seen the film.
I haven’t told them yet.
2. Finish 4b and check the answers.
Keys:loves,has read,will be,finished,will write,hasn’t read.
3. Finish 4c and check the answers.
Make conversations and complete the chart. (Follow the conversation on page 60)
Step 7 Homework
Sum up what they have learned in this lesson.
课堂作业
用所给单词的适当形式填空。
1. Judy has already _______ (finish) reading Little Women.
2. Tom and Mike have already _______ (decide) to learn Chinese on Internet.
3. Have you ________ (read) Alice in Wonderland yet?
4. Robinson ________ (have) already built a house on the island.
5. It often ________ (snow) in North China in winter.
参考答案:1.finished 2. decided 3. read 4. has; snows
教学反思
教学的目的不仅仅是教给学生知识,而且也要教给他们用所学知识解决问题的能力和技能。为了检查教学活动的效果,要及时对课堂的活动加以总结和评价,使得学生在激励中成长、进步。
八年级英语下册课件【篇4】
八年级下册英语教案
主题一:环保
范文1:How to Protect the Environment
Environmental protection is becoming increasingly important in today's world. As individuals, we all have a responsibility to do our part in protecting the environment. Here are some simple yet effective ways to make a difference.
Firstly, we can start by reducing our use of disposable items. For example, instead of using plastic bags when shopping, we can bring our own reusable bags. This simple change can greatly reduce the amount of plastic waste produced.
Secondly, we should also make an effort to conserve energy. Turning off lights and appliances when they are not in use is a simple step that everyone can take to save electricity. Additionally, using energy-efficient light bulbs and appliances can also make a significant impact.
Thirdly, we should promote the use of public transportation and carpooling. Using public transportation not only reduces air pollution, but also helps to decrease traffic congestion. Carpooling with others can also reduce the number of cars on the road, thus reducing carbon emissions.
Furthermore, we should be mindful of our water consumption. Simple actions such as turning off the tap while brushing our teeth or taking shorter showers can help to conserve water. Additionally, fixing any leaks or drips in our homes can prevent water wastage.
Lastly, we should promote recycling and proper waste disposal. Separating recyclable materials such as paper, plastic, and glass from our regular garbage can greatly reduce the amount of waste that goes into landfills. Additionally, we should avoid littering and always dispose of our trash in designated bins.
In conclusion, it is vital that we all take steps to protect the environment. By following these simple tips, we can make a positive impact on our planet and ensure a better future for generations to come.
主题二:健康生活
范文2:Tips for Maintaining a Healthy Lifestyle
Maintaining a healthy lifestyle is crucial for our overall well-being. Here are some tips for staying healthy.
Firstly, it is important to eat a balanced diet. This means including a variety of fruits, vegetables, whole grains, and lean proteins in our meals. Avoiding excessive sugar, salt, and unhealthy fats can also help to prevent various health problems.
Secondly, regular physical exercise is essential for maintaining a healthy lifestyle. Engaging in activities such as running, swimming, or cycling can improve cardiovascular health and strengthen muscles. It is recommended to aim for at least 30 minutes of exercise most days of the week.
Thirdly, getting enough sleep is equally important. Lack of sleep can negatively affect both our physical and mental health. It is recommended for teenagers to get between 8-10 hours of sleep each night.
Furthermore, it is crucial to manage stress effectively. Chronic stress can lead to a variety of health issues. Engaging in activities such as meditation, yoga, or spending time with loved ones can help to reduce stress levels.
Lastly, it is important to avoid harmful substances such as tobacco, alcohol, and drugs. These substances can have severe negative effects on our health.
In conclusion, maintaining a healthy lifestyle is essential for our well-being. By following these tips, we can ensure a healthier and happier life. Remember, small changes can lead to big improvements in our overall health.
八年级英语下册课件【篇5】
Unfortunately, as an AI language model, I am not able to provide you with a pre-written essay or essay templates, but I can give you some guidance on how to write a theme-based essay on the 8th-grade English textbook.
First, determine the theme of the lesson or chapter. For example, suppose the topic is about environmental protection. Your job is to write about the importance of protecting the environment. Start by conducting research on the topic, gather valuable information from reliable sources, define your thesis statement, and create an outline.
You can start your essay by introducing the topic, highlighting the current environmental issues, and explaining why environmental protection is crucial. You may share some exciting facts or statistics to grab your reader's attention. Then, develop your thesis statement, explaining what you learned about environmental protection from the lesson or chapter.
Next, you can divide your essay into sections, such as the causes and effects of environmental degradation, the role of people in environmental protection, and the steps that individuals can take to contribute to environmental protection.
In the first section, you can discuss the causes of environmental degradation, such as overpopulation, pollution, deforestation, and climate change. You can explain their negative impacts on the environment, such as the extinction of species, global warming, and increase in natural disasters.
In the second section, discuss the role of individuals in environmental protection. Talk about how people can use their daily activities to reduce their carbon footprints, such as conserving energy, using green technologies, and avoiding single-use plastics. You can also touch on the importance of governments, non-governmental organizations, and international coalitions on environmental protection.
In the final section, provide some steps that individuals can take to contribute to environmental protection, such as reducing their waste, conserving water, planting trees, and advocating for environmental policies.
Lastly, you should conclude your essay by summarizing your main points and restating your thesis statement. You can also provide some key takeaways and encourage your readers to take action towards environmental protection.
In summary, writing a theme-based essay on an English textbook requires you to conduct thorough research, establish a clear thesis, develop an outline, and organize your ideas effectively. With the right approach, you can create an informative and insightful essay that demonstrates your understanding of the subject matter.
八年级英语下册课件【篇6】
教学目标:知识目标:1.bought, taught and thought
2.the story
3.a song
能力目标:1. past tense
2.where did you do?
3.What did you do?
情感目标:When you play things, you must get good corporation with your players.
教学重点、难点:1.I am throwing the basketball.
2.hitting and throwing
教具、学具:some balls and story a tape and pictures
教学过程:[==]
一. Class opening and review
Review “ past tense” and “ future tense” verbs with a game. Write three columns of words on the blackboard and ask for volunteers to match them correctly. As each student makes a match, he or she says “Yesterday I___de. Today I___. Tomorrow I am going to__.
Introduce
Add “buy” “teach” and “think” to your “today” column. Ask the students to give you the future tense for each verb and write them under your “tomorrow” column. Then write “taught” “thought” “bought” in a different order than the other two columns, and ask the students to guess how they match with the present-tense verbs. Point out the similarities in spelling “bought” “taught” “thought”
Use the student book
Pause after Number 1 in the student book. Review the story so far. Today Jenny and Li Ming went to the store buy some clothes for Li Ming to the pictures in the student book. Who are they talking to?
Note the word “player” in the lesson. A “players” plays something, such as a sport.
Practice
Play “What’s wrong?” to practice the new past tense verbs, and other tenses and verbs.
Play “spelling Bee” to practice spelling any vocabulary in this unit.
Tech “Oh, what did you do?” in Number 3 of the student book.
Use the activity book
Number 2 in the activity book is a listening exercise. The students listen to each sentence on the audiotape and change it into the past—tense. Here’s how the audiotape goes:
板书:
Lesson4 Where did you go?
bought taught thought
Where did you do?
What did you do?
习题:
? 写出buy teach think 的过去式。
? 用Where did you do?练习说话。
? 用What did you do?练习说话。
八年级英语下册课件【篇7】
教学目标:
1、学生能正确说、读、写、用forget、remember
2、学生能用下列句子进行会话:
Do you remember this? Yes, it is a . (No, I forget.)
教学重点:
1、学生能正确说、读、写、用forget、remember
2、学生能熟练运用下列句子进行会话:
Do you remember this? Yes, it is a . (No, I forget.)
教学难点:学生能用下列句子进行会话:
Do you remember this? Yes, it is a . (No, I forget.)
教 具:词卡、录音机
课 时:1课时
教学过程:
一、问侯:
二、唱歌:
三、操练:复习25课单词
四、教授forget、remember
1、示范:
教师装作忘记然后又想起某物体的英语名称,如:装作忘记怎样说bag
和 book,教师用手势和面部表情让学生看明白意思,指关物体进行下列对话:
师:What is this? I forget how to say it in English. I forget. Say it, please, class.
生:I forget.
师:Oh, I remember. It’s a bag. I remember. Say it, please,class.
生:I remember.
然后,师再指另一件物品,
师:I forget what this is. What’s this? Do you remember?
生:It’s a book.
师:Oh, yes, you remember. Now I remember, too.
2、跟读课文录音:
3、练习:用游戏“Go Fish”的'变化形式做游戏。在游戏中,一生向另一生展示一张卡片并问:Do you remember this? 如对方有这张卡片,便回答:Yes, it is a . 如对方没有这张卡片,则回答No, I forget.
4、角色扮演:
5、《活动手册》 No.1
6、游戏:
五、结束本课教学:
作业:1、熟练本课对话
2、做《活动手册》
板书:
Lesson 26 Looking at Picture
remember forget
Do you remember this?
Yes, it is a .
八年级英语下册课件【篇8】
一、教案
1. 教学目标
a. 知识目标:学习并掌握关于描述人物特征的词汇和句型,如外貌特征、性格特征等。
b. 技能目标:培养学生运用所学词汇和句型进行描述和比较的能力。
c. 情感目标:培养学生的合作意识和团队精神,增强学生的自信心和积极性。
2. 教学重点
a. 学生能够正确运用所学的词汇和句型进行描述人物特征。
b. 学生能够用英语简单描述自己和他人的外貌特征和性格特征。
3. 教学难点
a. 学生能够用比较级和最高级句型对人物进行描述和比较。
b. 学生能够用英语详细描述人物的外貌特征和性格特征。
4. 教学准备
a. 教师准备:PPT课件、教学素材、小组活动准备、课堂展示材料等。
b. 学生准备:学生课本、学习笔记、课堂参与物品等。
5. 教学步骤
a. Step 1: 导入新课
- 呈现一张描述人物特征的照片,引发学生对外貌特征和性格特征的思考和讨论。
- 利用幻灯片展示,引导学生从图片中学习描述人物的词汇和句型。
b. Step 2: 学习新知
- 分组活动:将学生分成小组,每组分一位学生做模特,其他组员描述他的外貌特征和性格特征。组内对比,评选出最佳描述和最佳模特。
- 引导学生运用所学词汇和句型进行描述。
c. Step 3: 讲解语法
- 教师进行比较级和最高级句型的讲解,引导学生掌握运用。
d. Step 4: 实践运用
- 学生完成课本上的习题,对比和评价句子的准确性和描述的详细程度。
e. Step 5: 总结归纳
- 教师对本节课学习的重点、难点进行总结,梳理并提醒学生记忆。
二、反思
本节课的教学目标是学习并掌握描述人物特征的词汇和句型,培养学生描述和比较的能力。通过小组活动、实践运用等多种教学方法,让学生在实践中学习、运用和巩固所学内容。整堂课的教学过程基本顺利,但也存在以下几个问题:
1. 学生参与度不高:在小组活动中,个别学生参与度较低,导致整个小组工作效率不高。需要提前做好激发学生兴趣和参与的准备工作,引导学生积极参与。
2. 难度过高:部分学生对比较级和最高级句型掌握不牢固,导致在实践运用中出现困难。教师在讲解语法时需要使用简单明了的语言,配合具体例子进行解释,帮助学生理解和掌握。
3. 教学资源不足:课堂展示材料不够丰富,限制了学生的视觉体验和思维拓展。教师应准备更多的图片、视频等资源,以刺激学生的学习兴趣和主动探索。
总的来说,本节课的教学过程还有待改进和完善。需要更有趣、实践性的活动和教学资源,激发学生的学习兴趣和参与度。同时,在讲解语法知识时,要注意使用简单易懂的语言,帮助学生更好地理解和掌握。通过不断改进和反思,提高教学质量,促进学生的主动学习和全面发展。
八年级英语下册课件【篇9】
《人教版八年级下册英语课件》篇章主题范文
篇章一:My Summer Vacation(我的暑假)
My summer vacation was really enjoyable. First, I visited my grandma's house in the countryside. There, I helped her plant some vegetables and played with my cousins. We rode bikes and went swimming in the nearby lake. It was a lot of fun.
After that, I went to the beach with my family. We rented a cottage and spent a week there. We swam in the ocean and built sandcastles. We also had a bonfire and made s'mores. It was a great time with my family.
Finally, I went to a summer camp with my friends. We did a lot of outdoor activities like hiking, canoeing, and zip-lining. We also had campfires and shared stories. It was a great bonding experience with my friends.
Overall, my summer vacation was a great mix of relaxation and adventure. I can't wait to do it all again next year.
篇章二:The Benefits of Exercise(运动的好处)
Exercise is important for maintaining a healthy body and mind. Firstly, it can prevent a lot of health problems such as heart disease, high blood pressure, and obesity. Regular exercise also helps improve sleep and reduces stress and anxiety. It can even help prevent depression.
Exercise also has many benefits for the brain. It can improve cognitive function, including memory and thinking skills. It increases blood flow to the brain, which is important for maintaining brain health. Exercise also helps release endorphins, which are natural mood boosters.
Finally, exercise is a great way to socialize and make new friends. Joining a sports team or fitness group is a fun way to meet people who share your interests. It's also a great way to stay motivated and accountable.
In conclusion, exercise is essential for overall health and well-being. It has many physical and mental benefits and should be included in everyone's daily routine.
八年级英语下册课件【篇10】
教案设计:
本单元的教学目标主要包括:
1. 学会本单元的生词和短语,能够进行简单的拼写和记忆。
2. 掌握本单元的语法知识,能够进行简单的句型转换。
3. 培养学生的英语听说能力,能够听懂和说出简单的英语。
教学重点和难点:
教学重点:本单元的语法知识,包括时态、语态、主谓一致等。
教学难点:培养学生的英语听说能力,包括听懂和说出简单的英语。
教学方法:
1. 听力训练:通过听录音或者播放音频,让学生掌握本单元的生词和短语,并能够进行简单的句型转换。
2. 口语训练:通过对话练习,让学生掌握本单元的语法知识,并能够进行简单的句型转换。
3. 阅读训练:通过阅读文章,让学生掌握本单元的生词和短语,并能够进行简单的句型转换。
4. 游戏教学:通过游戏的形式,让学生更好地掌握本单元的语法知识。
教学评价:
教学评价主要包括课堂表现评价、作业评价和考试成绩评价。
课堂表现评价:通过课堂上的表现,如回答问题、积极参与课堂讨论、认真听讲等,来评估学生的学习效果。
作业评价:通过作业,如填空题、选择题、对话练习等,来评估学生对本单元的掌握情况。
考试成绩评价:通过学生的考试成绩,如单元测验、期末测验等,来评估学生对本单元的掌握情况。
反思:
通过这次教学,我发现学生对于本单元的语法知识掌握情况不够好,需要加强听力和口语训练,以及提高学生的阅读水平。
八年级英语下册课件【篇11】
新教材(冀教版)八年级英语(下册)
Lesson 25 Let’s Do An Experiment!
LESSON PRERATATION
Words and phrases:
science, experiment, fill, prove, theory, jar, upside, observe, right side up, upside down.
LESSON STRUCTURE
CLASS OPENING: Greed each other.
KEY STEPS:
STEP 1: Ask the class to discuss the questions in the “Think About It”. STEP 2: Let the students listen to the tape carefully with the following question:” Why does Danny say they should do this experiment outside?” ; “ What’s Brain’s theory? ”; “ What will Brain do?”; “Does Danny have the same theory as Brain’s?”
STEP3: listen to the tape again. The student’s better read the dialogue at the same time. After reading and listening, let the students fill in the chart by themselves.
What do we need when we do the experiment?
Water, a jar, A piece of cardboard
How do we do it?(steps)
1. fill…in…;
2. cover…with…;
3. turn…upside down.
What are Brain’s and Jenny’s theories?
1. The floor gets wet.
2. The floor won’t get wet.
Reason
discuss
Step 4: after filling it, ask the students to describe the experiment. Then, write it in the exercise-book.
Step 5. read the dialogue and act it out by the students.
Step 6. homework. Be ready to give us a morning report of tomorrow.
Language Notes:
Explain some sentences and phrases.
1.I fill a jar with water.
fill…with…
On hearing the news. Her eyes filled with tears.
2.I turn the jar upside down.
upside down
That picture is upside down.
3.I think the floor will get wet.
The days gets longer in spring.
4.I’m sure that the floor won’t get wet.
Tom ia sure that he will win the game.
5.We can prove who’s right.
My theory will prove (to be) right some day.
6.We’ll do the experiment and observe what will happen.
I observed her dance.
CLASS CLOSING:
Say good-bye to the students.
[1]
四年级上册英语课件(经典15篇)
我们常说,机会是留给有准备的人。为了使每堂课能够顺利的进展,教师通常会准备好下节课的教案,教案的作用就是为了缓解学生的压力,提升效率,教案对教学过程进行预测和推演,从而更好地实现教学目标。那么,你知道的幼儿园教案要怎么写呢?以下是由小编为你整理的《四年级上册英语课件(经典15篇)》,欢迎大家与身边的朋友分享吧!
四年级上册英语课件(篇1)
课题:Unit 4 My home
课时:第三课时
教学目标:
1、Learn the song
2、Learn the sentences of Part B
教学重点:The sentences
教学难点:The sentences
教学用具:Tape/recorder/pictures/things
教学过程:
Step1: Revision
1、Say out the fruits
2、Let’s paint
Step2: Let’s sing
1、Try to understand the meaning of the song
2、Listen to the recording
3、Sing after the tape
Step3: Let’s talk
1、Ask and answer
2、Listen to the recording
3、Try to understand the dialogue
4、Read the dialogue
5、Act the dialogue out
Step5:Summary and homework
板书设计:
Unit 4 My home
Study bathroom bedroom living room kitchen
Is this your bedroom?Yes,it is.\No,it isn’t.
作业布置:
1、Listen to the recorder
2、Read the sentences
3、Draw a picture.
四年级上册英语课件(篇2)
师库网 人民教育出版社,语文,四年级(上册), 尺有所短,寸有所长 教案1,师库网免费多媒体教案,新课标新课程课时全配套,教材分析、教学目标、教学重难点、学情分析、教学策略、教学活动、教学评价与反思全覆盖,同行借鉴、教法详实。 teachingplan-do-publicity-982-3190.html 师库网 人民教育出版社,语文,四年级(上册), 长城 教案1,师库网免费多媒体教案,新课标新课程课时全配套,教材分析、教学目标、教学重难点、学情分析、教学策略、教学活动、教学评价与反思全覆盖,同行借鉴、教法详实。 teachingplan-do-publicity-980-3191.html 师库网 人民教育出版社,语文,四年级(上册), 白公鹅 教案2,师库网免费多媒体教案,新课标新课程课时全配套,教材分析、教学目标、教学重难点、学情分析、教学策略、教学活动、教学评价与反思全覆盖,同行借鉴、教法详实。 teachingplan-do-publicity-979-3192.html 师库网 人民教育出版社,语文,四年级(上册), 白公鹅 教案1,师库网免费多媒体教案,新课标新课程课时全配套,教材分析、教学目标、教学重难点、学情分析、教学策略、教学活动、教学评价与反思全覆盖,同行借鉴、教法详实。 teachingplan-do-publicity-978-3193.html 师库网 人民教育出版社,语文,四年级(上册), 白鹅 教案2,师库网免费多媒体教案,新课标新课程课时全配套,教材分析、教学目标、教学重难点、学情分析、教学策略、教学活动、教学评价与反思全覆盖,同行借鉴、教法详实。 teachingplan-do-publicity-977-3194.html 师库网 人民教育出版社,语文,四年级(上册), 白鹅 教案1,师库网免费多媒体教案,新课标新课程课时全配套,教材分析、教学目标、教学重难点、学情分析、教学策略、教学活动、教学评价与反思全覆盖,同行借鉴、教法详实。 teachingplan-do-publicity-976-3195.html 师库网 人民教育出版社,语文,四年级(上册), 古诗两首 教案,师库网免费多媒体教案,新课标新课程课时全配套,教材分析、教学目标、教学重难点、学情分析、教学策略、教学活动、教学评价与反思全覆盖,同行借鉴、教法详实。 teachingplan-do-publicity-974-3196.html 师库网 人民教育出版社,语文,四年级(上册), 古诗两首 教案1,师库网免费多媒体教案,新课标新课程课时全配套,教材分析、教学目标、教学重难点、学情分析、教学策略、教学活动、教学评价与反思全覆盖,同行借鉴、教法详实。 teachingplan-do-publicity-975-3197.html
四年级上册英语课件(篇3)
新课标指出:基础教育阶段英语课程的目标是以学生语言技能、语言知识、情感态度、学习策略和文化意识的发展为基础,培养学生的综合语言运用能力。教学目标的设定,遵循的是明确具体,可操作性的原则。基于这样的认识,我确定以下教学目标:
(1)知识目标:能够理解并朗读let’s read部分的对话;
能完成书本中的排序练习。
(2)能力目标:学习“问路”及“指点方向”用语,并能在具体的情景中使用。
(3)情感目标:培养学生团结友爱、乐于助人的良好品质。
使学生愿意在小组活动中积极与他人合作、互相帮助、共同完成学习任务。
本课时是一堂阅读教学课,其中涉及到的词汇句型比较多,通过对教学目标以及六年级学生情况分析,我认为重难点应该这样把握:
1.本课时的教学重点是能够听、说、认读Let’s read 部分的对话。
2.本课时的难点是能够理解对话中出现的新时态和指点路线的新语言,如:What are you going to do after school? Get off at the cinema .Then walk straight for three minutes.
三、说教法
新课程倡导任务型的教学模式,让学生在教师的指导下,通过感知、体验、实践、参与、合作等方式,实现任务的目标,感受成功。在学习过程中进行情感和策略调整,以形成积极的学习态度,促进语言实际运用能力的提高。同时英语课程要面向全体学生,注重素质教育,要关注每个学生的情感,激发他们学习英语的兴趣,帮助他们建立学习的成就感和自信心,使他们在学习的过程中发展综合语言运用能力,提高人文素养,培养创新精神。
基于以上认识,我以新课程为指导,以学生为主体,让学生通过游戏、对话、思考,观察等来体验语言,体验生活,体验学习的过程与快乐。
(1)情境法。通过呈现地图创设问路情境,让学生在形象的语言环境中学习、运用新知。
(2)任务型教学法。每一个环节我都设计了不同的活动任务,,使学生在“说“与”做“中达到“用”的目的,发展学生思维能力、创新意识和各种语言应用能力,培养学生团结友爱、乐于助人的良好品质。
(3)视听法、表演法、讲授法、对话法相结合,以“听、读”为基础,“交际”为主的教学手段,引导学生完成阅读,并学会指路用语。
(4)多媒体等辅助法。运用课件,板书等直观的现代教学手段,创造轻松愉快的教学氛围,调动学生主动参加课堂的积极性。
四、说学法
小学六年级学生已经学了将近四年的英语,已掌握了基本的听、说、读、写能力,已具备了一定的自学能力。因此可在教学中充分发挥他们的自主精神,培养他们的自学能力。但他们仍然具有儿童的一些基本特性,如好奇心强,好表现,善模仿等。游戏、活动是他们最乐于接受的学习方式。考虑到学生这样的特点,我设计了循序渐进,动静结合的教学环节。通过对话,培养学生的口语能力;通过听课文录音,设计不同程度的问题,培养学生听力与分析短文的能力;通过小组,两人对话,培养学生的合作能力;通过设计排序作业,培养学生阅读,自学能力。
五、说教学手段
教学手段是为了实现预期的教学目的。针对英语课堂的特点,我采用多媒体辅助结合简洁的板书设计来呈现我的课堂。
六、说教学程序
合理安排教学程序是教学成功的关键。教学过程不单是传授与学习文化科学知识的过程,同时也是促进学生全面发展的过程。教师在引导学生掌握知识的同时,全面发展学生各方面的能力,针对学生的认识状况及本课教材的特点,我安排了以下几个教学环节:
第一环节:游戏导入,激发兴趣
课前自由对话完成之后,我直接运用游戏:课件快速呈现一个单词,让学生说一说,拼一拼。我呈现的是两种词汇:一个是本单元已经学习过的地点词汇,另外一个是本节课需要了解的一些词汇,这些词汇学生以前已经接触过,通过游戏再次出现,为本课时教学作铺垫。
设计意图:游戏是小学生很喜欢的一种活动。但是六年级的学生已经比较成熟,唱唱跳跳的游戏不是很适合他们。采用猜单词这样的游戏,学生更加容易接受,同时为教学做铺垫。时间安排在4-5分钟左右。
第二环节:活动教学,巩固句型
首先我呈现一张街区地图,让学生熟悉各个地点之后,问学生excuse me ,where is the post office ?学生会回答:It’s near /next to…示范之后,我让学生来做一做小交警,以四人小组为单位,一个学生做小交警,另外三个问路。 S1:excuse me ,where is the …..?S2:It’s near /next to …..
设计意图:这个环节设计,我主要是让学生学会看地图,并巩固询问和指点方向的句型where is the …..?以及回答 It’s near /next to …..把枯燥的句型问答放入一个合适的情境中,学生的兴趣就会增大。同时小组活动,培养学生的合作能力与团结有爱的精神。时间安排在5分钟左右.
第三环节:借助地图,学习新知
教师在学生全面了解了地图中各个地点的位置之后,问学生 I want to see animals. Where can I go? How can I get to the bookstore?在教学短语want to的同时,为学生输入语言see animals。学生会用 You can go to the bookstore. You can go on foot.回答。接着同样问学生 I want to see a film. Where can I go? How can I get to the cinema?引出短语 by No.3 bus.学生体会乘坐几路车的说法。同样用 I want to post a letter.. Where can I go? How can I get to the post office? 引出get off at the cinema.教学短语get off,同时教学它的反义词get on。
最后教师问:I want to by a pair of shoes after school. Where can I go? How can I get to the shoestore? 引出walk straight for three minutes教学。这个句型应该重点进行操练。因此我设计了一个chant来巩固。在这个环节的教学中,把我们课文的另一个难点也设计进去,即 What are you going to do after school? I want to…..因为我上面已经说了很多可以做的事情,I want to…学生在这里就会聪明地运用进来了。
设计意图:这个环节是逐步击破新授课重难点的一个环节,教师通过想做的事情,问学生应该上哪里去,一步一步引出乘坐公交车、上下车、笔直走的英语说法。 “Be going to “句型是个新内容,因此要让学生有所感知,我设计的是一个采访任务,学生在采访中互相了解,增加友谊,完成学习目标。小学生的接受能力很强,但是也不能一下子习得多有的东西,因此我从易到难,听说结合,让学生学会思考、观察,循序渐进,符合小学生身心发展的规律。时间安排15分钟。
第四环节:听说结合,回归课文
这个环节,我通过让学生听课文录音,回答6个问题:
What is Mike going to do?
Where is he going?
Where is the shoe store?
Which bus can he take?
Is the hospital on the left ?
学生在前面已经掌握了课文中的重难点,因此在听录音的时候能够大体听得懂。回答问题之后我让学生跟读课文,并进行表演,进一步巩固新知,最后完成课本的排序练习。
设计意图:课堂教学最终要回归文本,学生学习课文才会对整节课有一个整体的了解把握。通过听录音的形式,培养学生的听力能力,通过表演对话的形式,培养学生说、演的能力。通过排序练习,巩固本节课的重点知识。时间安排10分钟。
第五环节:联系实际,巩固拓展
这一环节我这样设计:课件显示海盐镇区域图,其中有我们的学校以及一医院,电影院,图书馆等公共场所,师生就这些地点进行问答练习:Where is the ….?How can I get to the …? You can take the No…. bus. You can get off at the …. . You can walk straight for minutes. 在问答完成之后教师出示打乱顺序的句子,让学生根据我们镇的地图进行排序。
设计意图:英语教学的最终目标是能够进行运用。课堂中的知识联系实际,运用到实际中,学生更加感兴趣,同时实现了最终教学目标。同时课堂作业是教学效果最直接的反映,我设计通过让学生看地图进行排序的作业,训练学生的综合语言运用能力。更能及时给教师反馈。时间安排5-6分钟。
第六环节:课下作业设计
课下作业设计了必做题与选做题两个内容。这样的设计我是考虑到了学生程度的不同,每个学生都会尽力去完成自己能够做到的作业。
七、说板书设计
板书的设计,我遵循简洁易懂,重点突出的原则。因此,我把重点及地图呈现在黑板上。
四年级上册英语课件(篇4)
教学目标
1、 知识与技能:学习单词hop skate swim 及词组ride a bike,
学习句型“Can you…?Yes, I can.”让学生能听懂,会说,会用此
句型与别人交谈。
2.过程与方法: 通过问答法,使学生能够熟练运用句型“Can you…?
Yes I can.”于日常交谈。
3.情感态度与价值观:培养学生能够正确运用所学内容进行日常交际
和积极用英语表达的习惯。
教学重难点
1、 能听懂,认读单词hop skate swim 及词组ridea bike 。
2、 能用主题句型“Can you…?Yes, I(we)can./No,I(we)can t.”
与别人交谈。
教具
图片、录音机及相关磁带、 投影器、球
教 学 过程
Step1 Warming up
Free talk.
Step2 Presentation
1、 师出示两张人物图片,并张贴黑板。
T: I have two friends.
Heis Bob.She is Kate.
然后教师扮演Kate并面向Bob图片问“Hi, Bob! Can you hop?”再扮演Bob,并配合肢体动作答“Yes, I can.”
2、 师教生用手指木偶法问和答。
3、 生分两部分,配合肢体动作,跟老师说“hop hop hop Can you hop?Yes,I can.”
4、 师生配合肢体动作问答。
T: Hello ,___! Can you hop?
S: Yes, I can.
T: Hello, ___! Can you hop?
S: Yes, I can.
T: Hello ,___! Can you hop?
S: Yes, I can.
师画简笔画“skate”,幷出示词卡配合肢体动作教学生读skate skate skate 。
T: Hello ,___! Can you skate?
S: Yes, I can.
T: Hello, ___! Can you skate?
S: No, I canˊt.
师画简笔画“swim”,幷出示词卡,配合肢体动作教生读swim swim swim。
T: Hello ,___! Can you swim?
S: Yes。I can.
T: Hello, ___! Can you swim?
S: No, I canˊt.
师画简笔画“ride a bike”,幷出示短语卡片,配合肢体动作教生读ridea bike ride a bike
T: Hello ,___! Can you ride a bike?
S: Yes, I can.
T: Hello, ___! Can you ride a bike?
S: No, I canˊt.
5、师教生以Chant形式,伴随肢体动作,学习生词及词组,并感知句型。
hop hop hop Can you hop? Yes,I can.
skate skate skate Can you skate? Yes, I can.
swim swim swim Can you swim? Yes, I can.
ride a bike ride a bike Can you ride a bike?Yes,I can.
Step3 Drills
1、学生两人一组问和答。
Can you hop?
Yes, I can./No, I can t.
Can you skate?
Yes , I can./ No, I can t.
Can you swim?
Yes, I can./ No, I can t.
Can you ride a bike?
Yes, Ican./ No, I can t.
2.Sing the song “Can you swim?”
(1) Ss sing after T.
(2) Ss sing after therecorder.
(3) 师教生用hop skate swim ride a bike替换歌词,再唱这首歌曲
3、Play a game
唱歌传球,歌声停时,谁传给谁球,他们就用型“Can you…?Yes,I can./No,I can’t.问答。
Step4 Consolidation and development
1、3.Listen andtick放录音,让一名学生通过投影片写答案,其它同学评判对错。
2、让生分组用“Canyou…?Yes, Ican./No,I can t”自编对话表演。
Step5 Homework
Play a game
唱歌传球,歌声停时,谁传给谁球,他们就用句型
“Can you…?Yes,I can./No,I can’t.问答。
板书设计
Lesson 1 I can swim
Can youhop/skate/swim/ride a bike?
Yes, I can.
四年级上册英语课件(篇5)
Recycle 1第三课时教学重点:Unit1-3单元中要求听、说、读、写的单词。
教学难点:Play a game的内容综合了前三单元的主要句型,学生需要一个练习过程,然后过渡到综合运用。
教具准备:
1.Unit1-3单词卡及短语卡片。
2.小旗帜。
3.供学生表演用的实物道剧:书、书包等。4.教材相配套的教学录音带。
教学过程:
(一)热身/复习(Warm-up/Revision)
1.看单词卡读出单词并说出中文,复习1-3单元要求四会的单词。
2.做“拼读单词列队比赛”
将全班分成两组,教师发给每个学生一张字母卡片。游戏开始,教师说一个单词,如door,或出示一张门的图片,两个组持d,o,o,r字母的学生应立即站到讲台前按顺序站好队,先按正确次序排好队的为优胜。
3.复习表示颜色的单词,做“猜颜色”游戏。
教师先准备一些单词的图片。如白色的兔子,红色的小汽车,黑色的书包,绿色的上衣等。游戏开始,请一名学生到前面来猜,猜的学生面对全班站立,再请另一名学生上前站在他身后,抽出一张图片高举在手中并说:“This is a plane(car).What color is it? Please guess.”猜的学生可以问全班:“Is it red(black)?”等,全班学生答:“Yes.”或“No.”猜对后可以换另一位学生继续猜。
(二)呈现新课(Presentation)
1.教师出示第35页的图片投到到黑板上。让学生读出上面的问题。
2.将全班学生分成几个小组,通过回答楼梯上的问题的回答来进行竞赛。可男生与女生比,小组之间,小队之间比等等。答对的小组小旗帜就向上移,看哪个最先登山顶峰。
3.让学生根据图中所给的单词和词组,对班中的同学进行描述。
4.教师问学生在前三个单元都学了哪些方面的知识?给学生分成三大组,教师将my classroom, my schoolbag, my friends 三个话题分给各组,让每组学生就本组所分到的话题拟定几个问题。
5.教师在黑板上归纳各组拟定的问题,并进行修改。
6.给时间让学生根据黑板上的问题进行对话练习。
(三)趣味操练(Practice)
1.看图写单词
这是让学生们复习学过单词的游戏,教师事先把需复习的11个单词用简笔画画在小黑板上或大白纸上,先不要让学生们看见,然后将全班按前后左右四人一组分成若干小组。竞赛开始,教师将小黑板或白纸挂起来,让学生们看一分钟,然后收起来,再给学生们两分钟时间将看到的单词写出来,写得最多最正确的组获胜。
2.找对子
教师将20个单词的图片贴在黑板上,另外将20张对应的单词卡扣着放在讲台上,然后让参赛的两组学生逐一上来抽卡片,抽出卡片后先要举给学生们看,然后把黑板上相应的图摘下来并将单词读出来,找对读对的得2分,找对读错给1分,找错了的不得分,卡片全部抽完后,得分多的为优胜。
(四)扩展性活动(Add-activities)
猜袋中物品数量
将全班分成若干小组,每组抽一人到前面,背对着班级。教师拿一个袋子,并向学生们借一些书本,铅笔,钢笔,橡皮等,放入袋中,然后让各组学生轮流猜袋子里东西的数目,猜对的给该组记10分。
板书设计: Recycle 1
What’s in your classroom?
Who’s your math teacher?
How many story-books do you have?
What’s in your pencil-case?
What’s in your schoolbag?
Do you like maths?
Who’s your best friend?
What colour is your schoolbag?
What colour is your English book? 教学反思:
四年级上册英语课件(篇6)
教学目标:
1、 能听懂,会说:An egg? An ice cream? Some cakes? A glass of milk? A glass of orange juice? 及其回答Yes, please. No , thank you. = No, thanks.
2、能用简短的句子征求对方的意见。
重点难点:
1、能听懂,会说:Some cakes? An egg? An ice cream? A glass of milk? A glass of orange juice?及其回答Yes, please. No , thank you. = No, thanks.
2、能用简短的句子征求对方的意见。
教学准备:
T:Good morning, boys and girls.
S:Good morning, Miss Yang.
S:Nice to meet you,too.
S: Fine, thank you. And you?
T: I’m happy. Sit down,please.
2、Free talk(Let’s free talk.Ok?)
对话中喊学生回答问题时,不断复现you, please.
(1)T:Good moring, what’s your name ?
S: Nice to meet you,too.
S: Fine, thank you. And you ?
(2)T: Good morning, Look, this is my new sweater.
S:How nice!/It’s smart./It’s pretty./It’s nice. T: Thanks. (6, 7 coat, 8watch三人)
(3)课件1 Thanks =Thank you 谢谢你。
Step 2:Presentation and practice.
1、(接上面引入)T: Look at my box . S5: How nice.
T: Guess ? guess ? What’s in the box ? 老师提示a?? (目的复习许多旧单词,练习了声调的猜测,为下面学句型的声调做铺垫)
生猜测:a ?? a?? a?? (猜到orange 为止,如猜不到提示It’s a kind of fruit .猜到后指一学生说open the box,please.S:OK!/All right.T:thanks.体现前后的衔接。)
T:oh,it’s an orange.同时把盒子放回前面。
2、通过orange,学习An/a?? Yes,please. Some?? No, thanks. (目的以此环节通过旧单词orange, 学习新句型,并在此总结了带an 的单词,两个的,以及一些的)
(1)T: (师手拿苹果,问学生)Look at this small orange.
T: (师作吃状,示意学生)I’d like to eat it.yam,yam,yam. Do you want to eat? (走到一学生跟前) An orange ?
T:(引导学生说)Yes,please. (师同时出示词条Yes, please.)
教读三遍,指读一组。(学生说时往黑板走去贴词条Yes, please.) T—S—S 操练(师拿着苹果问一学生)Anorange ?
S接过苹果Yes, please.继续问下一个,操练一组。苹果就放在最后一位同学那。
(2)T:师从讲桌上边出示An/A??边解释:当你想询问别人要一个东西吗?可以这样问(边说边走向黑板,贴词条)
(3)T:(回到电脑前) an orange? 你还知道其他的带an 的单词吗?Do you know the other words with “an ”?
S:an apple , an elephant, an ice cream (同时课件3呈现,带读一遍)
3、学习an ice cream T:Guess? Guess? What is it?
T:师采用各种方法教学生认读单词 老虎读,猫读 从低到高读 慢读到快读 指读几个, 两人读,四人读,一排读,小组读 (冰淇淋对于孩子很难读,所以设计各种各样的方法练习读这个单词)
T: (示意cold)引导学生说No, thanks. 出示词条No, thanks.边说当你不想要的时候就说No ,thanks. T与一学生示范,Work in pairs.
4、Now, I’m hungry .(师作饥饿状)通过饥饿引出蛋糕,学习cake蛋糕 T:Oh,it’s a cake. Read after me.cake,cake.
(1)音标教读k ei k.
(2)跟写单词show me your figers and follow me.
(3)升降调教读 One by one T:What is it?
S:学生会用汉语告诉老师是蛋糕。 T与一学生示范A cake ? Yes,please./ No, thanks.
T:师出示课件两个蛋糕,How to say ?
S:学生会说two cakes. T:师出示课件一些蛋糕,How to say ?
S:学生可能会说cakes, 也可能会说some cakes.
S:指名让学生组词Who can make phrases with “some”?
(4) S:some cakes ? T: Yes,please. (师同时出示词条some??)
5、通过一首儿歌,复习cake, ice cream并稍作休息 Chant: An an ice cream? No,no,thanks. Some some cakes ? Yes, yes, please.(教读,齐读)
(1)T:(师作饥渴状)thirsty, thirsty,I’m very thirsty . I must drink some juice.(师顺手拿起果汁,喝完后yam, yam,yam) 教读juice ,指读一组, What colour is the juice ? What juice ?
T:This is orange juice. What else juice do you know ?(生组词)
(2)T:师边把果汁倒入杯子中,边说:This is a glass.(教读,指读) 左手说a glass, 右手说juice. 三四遍 停止倒果汁,This is a glass of juice. 教读a glass of juice 师拿起果汁,问一学生:A glass of juice ? S:学生回答Yes, please,就可以喝一口,继续问其他同学,连环问,直至果汁喝完。
(3)学习牛奶 T: Oh, there’s no juice.Close your eyes.Let’s change. (师边倒牛奶,边重复说milk,milk ,milk) Open your eyes,what is it? S:milk T:师教读milk T:(一杯牛奶)How to say? T: Who can make phrases with “a glass of??” Work in pairs.
7、儿歌复习饮料 Chant: Juice, juice, juice,
A glass of juice? No, no, thanks; Milk, milk, milk,
A glass of milk ?
Yes,yes,please.
8、招聘启示 KFC招聘启示 KFC招聘营业员,
(2)能用英语给客人打招呼。
(3)能用英语询问客人想要些什么。 师示范,学生六人一组练习,展示
T: Today Nancy and Yang Ling are going out. They want to buy somethings to eat and drink. Let’s listen to the tape.
2、S read the books and repeat the tape.
3、S read the text by themselves.
T: Now, boys and girls, Let’s review,think over今天学到了什么?what have you learned this lesson?
上完这节课,你还想学习哪些食物饮料类的知识?after this lesson,what else food do you want to learn?你打算怎样去学习呢 ?
1、Listen and repeat the text 5 times.
2、Make a dialogue with your friends.
四年级上册英语课件(篇7)
一、教材分析
本教材的教学目的是激发学生学习英语的兴趣,培养他们学习英语的积极心态,使他们初步建立学习英语的自信心;培养学生具有一定的语感和良好的语音、语调、书写基础,以及良好的学习习惯;使他们初步具备用英语进行简单日常交流的能力。同时培养学生的观察、记忆、思维、想象和创造能力,适当介绍中西方文化,培养学生的爱国主义精神,增强世界意识,为学生的进一步学习奠定良好的基础。
本册重点学习学校课室及功能室的名称、分布和不同的功能;学习时间的表达以及描述不同时间进行的日常活动;学习服装名称及其单、复数的使用习惯;学习表示天气状况的形容词;学习有关衣服和鞋子的大小、评价价格、颜色和款式;学习农场上常见的牲畜和蔬菜名称以及包含名词复数形式的一般疑问句。
二、学生情况分析
学生经过了两年年半的学习,大部分学生对于英语这门学科还是比较感兴趣的,学习积极性比较高。但也有少数学生由于遇到困难,学习兴趣会随之减弱,出现纪律松懈,作业拖拉的现象,学习效果差,又缺乏家长的积极配合,学习英语的能力已经出现两极分化现象。尤其从这学期开始,对学生又提出了新的要求:培养听、说、读、写的技能。所以教师应该面向全体学生,以学生的发展为宗旨,始终把激发学生的学习兴趣放在首位,引导学生端正学习态度,掌握良好的学习方法,培养学生良好的学习习惯。
三、教学目标
1、能听懂、会说12组会话,并能进行简单的交流。
2、能听、说、认读60个单词和词组并能听、说、读、写61个单词和24个句子(包括学校、时间、衣服、天气、购物、农场动物、数字、颜色等几个话题),并能简单运用。
3、能听、做6个“TPR”活动。
4、能学会3个小制作。
5、能唱8首歌曲。
6、能听、说、吟唱7首歌谣。
7、能完成6个自我评价活动。
8、能听懂6个幽默小故事。
9、能了解6项简单的中西方文化知识。
四、创新教学设计
1、认真备课,钻研教材,抓紧课堂教学,做到当堂内容当堂掌握。
2、融会话教学于情景表演之中。
3、巧用实物、卡片、chant 及肢体语言等来帮助进行单词教学。
4、利用读写课等时间对学生进行单词书写的指导。
5、继续加强基础部分的教学,同时采用小老师带徒弟的办法,帮助学习相对滞后的同学。
6、针对部分学生“喂不饱”的现象,本学期继续把C部分的教学内容滲透到A\\B的教学环节中,同时继续加强口语练习和日常用语教学,以不断扩充学生的英语信息量。
7、在课堂上尽力运用小组竞赛法,调动学生学习英语的积极性。
8、要求学生在课余时间尽量的运用已经学习的英语进行对话。
五、教学进度安排
内容课时周次
行为习惯教育1课时第一周
Unit16课时第
一、第二周
Unit26课时第
三、第四周
Unit36课时第
五、第六周
Recycle13课时第七周
Unit46课时第
八、第九周
机动复习、期中检测3课时第十周
Unit56课时第十
一、第十二周
Unit66课时第十
三、第十四周
Recycle23课时第十五周
机动复习6课时第十
四年级上册英语课件(篇8)
各位评委老师好,今天我说课的内容是PEP教材四年级上册Unit 2My schoolbag中的第一课时,其包括:说教材,说目标,说教材重难点,说学生,说教学方法和教具以及说教学过程这六部分。
首先是,说教材
本节课是人教版小学英语PEP教材四年级上册Unit 2My schoolbag中的第一课时,内容包括P.A Let’s learn、P.C Let’s sing 两部分。本课的主要内容是学习关于书本的生词,以及会运用句型How many„do you have? I have„;会唱歌曲“Books and pencils”。学好本课为更好地学习本单元有关学习用品的话题奠定了基础,也为下面第四册Unit 1 Our school的学习做好了铺垫。
其次是,说目标
1、教学目标:依据新课标要求、本课的内容和学生现有的认知水平我确定以下教学目标:A知识目标:能够听、说、认、读本课六个生词English book,math book, Chinese book, story-book, notebook, schoolbag,会运用句型How many„do you have? I have„.并通过创设真实情境来运用及交流;学唱歌曲“Books and pencils”。B技能目标:能综合运用所学语言进行交流,将新学词汇运用于句型中,发展学生自主学习的能力。C情感目标:通过本课的学习使学生乐于听、说英语,乐于模仿,积极参与,培养学生的合作精神。
然后是说,教学重难点
a本课的重点是掌握单词,做到能听、说、认、读,并学会歌曲“Books and pencils”;b难点是将新学词汇运用于句型How many„do you have? I have„中,联系生活来运用及交流 下面是、说学生
1、四年级学生的年龄在十岁左右,他们活泼好动,表现欲、参与欲非常强烈,喜欢直观形象思维,对歌曲、游戏、模仿特别感兴趣。针对其年龄特点,课堂上要以表扬为主,注重培养学习英语的兴趣,把知识融合在符合他们兴趣的任务活动中。
接着是,说教法
英语的习得过程是新旧语言知识不断交替复现的过程。在本节课导入新课时,我充分利用新旧知识的联系温故知新。在操练单词时,利用新旧知识之间的相同点强化记忆。我还发挥英语歌曲、chant、游戏比赛以及TPR活动的激趣作用,让学生在愉快的气氛中,通过多种活动来操练重点单词和句型,突破教学重难点,并在教学过程中贯穿对学生的形成性评价。再者是,说过程
首先,我会问学生书包里都有什么,让学生积极主动地参与课堂学习。然后再拿出自己的书包,让学生猜测老师书包里有什么。在此过程中,再一一拿出六本书,边拿边说:I have 6 books: an English book, a Chinese book, a math book, a notebook and two story-books.接着出示单词卡片,老师一一教授本课生词:English book, math book, Chinese book, story-book, notebook, schoolbag。
接着,进行单词识记练习。多媒体屏幕上出现图片及单词,五秒钟后图片及单词消失,让学生凭记忆找出相对应的单词和图片,老师给找对的同学给小贴贴奖励或给该组记分。通过单词练习引出句型,引导学生用数字回答句型How many„do you have?,先个别操练,再分组,后全班练习。
然后是学唱歌曲“Books and pencils”,要求学生边听音乐边配以恰当的动作,边唱边做。(拓展练习这三个环节的设计,既让学生在活动中运用了所学的语言,又激发了学生学习的兴趣。最后一首歌把整堂课的气氛推向了高潮,使整堂课显得更加完整、有序。)最后布置学生的: Homework。
四年级上册英语课件(篇9)
1、复习。
T: Hello, S1. Nice to meet you. S1: Nice to meet you ,too.
T(向另一个学生): Hi, what’s your name? S2: My name is S2.
T: Glad to meet you. S: Glad to meet you too.
2、呈现课文。
T:Now, listen to the tape please. What are they saying?
鼓励学生大胆地说出自己听到的句子,并板书句型“Good morning.”“How are you?”“I’m fine, thank you.”分别用以上句子向学生问候。 游戏——Chain game(锁链游戏) S:How are you? S1: Fine, thank you. Hello, how are you? S2: Fine, thanks.
T: Look, this is He is my brother.
板书句子“He is my brother.”,带读,让学生理解“This is”和brother的含义。
走到一学生面前。 T: Hello, how are you? S: Fine, thanks.
T(指着旁边一个男生问):Is he your brother? S: No, he isn’t.
3、听课文A部分,跟读
4、三人(每组至少有一名男学生)小组练习。
Step 3 Practice 操练和运用课文B部分。
1、问学生们想不想念他们的老朋友Dino,请他们运用今天学习的句型向Dino问好。(Dino可由学生或教师扮演)
2、结合以上表演向Dino介绍你的新同学。
3、听课文B部分录音,分角色表演。
四年级上册英语课件(篇10)
教学目标: 1. 进一步复习巩固职业类单词和主要句型。
2. 能听懂、会说、会读句型it's cold today, isn't it? guess! what do you want to be? i want to be … 并获得运用所学语言进行交际的能力。
3. 了解辅音字母组合dr和tr在单词中的读音。
4. 能演唱歌曲they sing happily.
重点难点:句型it's cold today, isn't it?的理解和句型what do you want to be? i want to be …的实际运用。
教 学 过 程
用时:25分钟
第一步:复习(单元重点内容)
用时:5分钟
1.t: (ppt 1 显示课题)hello, boys and girls. nice to see you again.
t: 在第三单元中,我们已经学习了询问别人姓名和年龄的句型,你还记得吗?现在我们一起来复习复习吧!(ppt2呈现句型,带读)
t: now let's watch a cartoon.你能记住动画中的句子吗,为动画配音吗?(pp3播放g1动画)
t: is it interesting?其实这个故事就藏在我们的英语书上。open your books at page 28. please read in pairs.
t: can you try to answer the questions?(ppt4呈现问题,待学生回答后逐题呈现答案)what's the girl's name? yes, she's mingming. and how old is she? she's two. the girl has a doll.小女孩还有个娃娃呢?what's the doll's name? it's mingming, too. how old is the doll? it's two, too.
t: 好!现在我们来试着给动画故事配音吧!(再次播放动画,静音)
第二步:完成各版块教学
用时:15分钟
t: 看完了mingming和娃娃的故事,我们再来看看这个故事吧。(ppt5播放e部分动画)now, look at your books, page 27. read after me, please. 跟我读。
t: 在这个故事中,(ppt6呈现句子及中文)yang ling说的it's cold today, isn't it?是一个反问句,意思是"今天很冷,不是吗?" 英语中的对话很多时候是以谈论天气开始的。因为天冷,所以一群老人正在运动。(ppt6再呈现老人们)look at that old woman in the red sweater? (ppt6呈现句子)who's she? (停1秒)yes, she's yang ling's grandmother. so yang ling says 'she's my grandmother.' (ppt6呈现句子)how old is she? about sixty? 大约60岁?guess! (停1秒)no, she's eighty. (ppt6呈现句子)
t: now, listen and repeat.现在请大家跟读一遍。 (ppt6完整呈现对话,点击播放句子读音)
t: ok. please try to act this dialogue in pairs. one will be yang ling, one will be su yang. 请你和同桌分角色表演这一小段对话。先请这两位同学给大家做个示范吧。(学生示范)
t: have a try, please. 大家开始表演吧。
t: 在本单元中,我们还学习了一个重要的话题:如何谈论别人的职业。请看这些句子。(ppt7呈现句子)
t: now, let's look, guess and say. (ppt8-10呈现图片和句子)
t: 我想每位同学都有自己理想中的职业,what do you want to be? 你想做什么呢?你问别人以后想从事某种职业时,可以说what do you want to be? (ppt11呈现句型)跟我说一次(注意看教师的口型)。别人问你时,你可以这样回答i want to be a/an …(ppt11呈现句型,带读) t: 下面我们就用这两个句子做个调查,在调查中要及时记录调查的结果。ask and answer one by one, and write down the record. 我们来给大家做个示范。
(教师和四个学生作示范:教师和学生a问答后,转述他的答案后记录在书上的表格内)
t: (师生示范结束后,展示结果,特写拍书上的表格)ok, let's have a look. how many boys and girls want to be a teacher? two. how many boys and girls want to be a cook? one.
t: 同学们学会了吗?please begin. 请你们开始调查吧。(停几秒)ok. 课后不要忘记和同学分享一下你的调查结果。
t: 又到了练习读音的时候了。(ppt12呈现图片)look at the picture. i can see a pair of trousers in the tree. (点击出现单词trousers和tree) what's this? yes, it's a blue dress. (同上) and the dress is the driver's.(同上) (ppt12呈现完整的句子,带读单词和句子)
t: 字母组合dr通常读作/dr/,组合tr通常读作/tr/。请大家记住它们。
t: 在本单元的最后,让我们来学唱一首和职业有关的歌曲吧。(准备播放歌曲,ppt13画面停留在歌曲题目)they sing happily.他们唱得真开心。(ppt14播放歌曲)
t: read after me. (ppt15呈现歌词)
t: now let's listen to it again. this time you can try to sing. (ppt16再播放歌曲)
这首歌曲可以很好地帮我们复习学过的职业类单词,希望你在课后也可以练习唱一唱。
(结束语)
t: 在第三单元中,我们一起学习了有关询问他人年龄、职业等相关的语言知识,还学习了歌曲they sing happily. 相信你在今后的学习生活中能很好的运用所学到的知识进行交流。 bye!
四年级英语上册复习教案
四年级上册英语课件(篇11)
篇一:新闽教版四年级上册英语教案
篇二:闽教版小学英语四年级上册第八单元小测
闽教版小学英语四年级上册第八单元小测
一、写出下列图片的英语表达。
二、选词填空。(将正确的选项填在括号里)1.(a./ b.the c.a 2.()______ do you spend it? 3.()do you ______ a family dinner? a.hasb.havec.had a.in b.atc.on
三、写出下列新年做的事情的英语表达。
篇三:小学四年级 上册第八单元教案
篇四:2016年闽教版英语四年级上册全册教案第一学期全套教学设计
闽教版小学英语四年级上册教案 unit 1our classroom 教学目标
◆语言知识目标
1.学习单词grade,class,classroom,并能够初步运用see,again,our等单词。2.学习句型:i’m in class...,grade....3.学习字母组合ar在单词中的发音。4.学唱歌曲:in the classroom.5.功能:能用英语表达自己所在的班级名称。
◆语言技能目标
1.能认读和正确书写单词grade,class和classroom。
2.能准确使用句型i’m in class...,grade....来描述自己所在的班级。
◆情感态度
培养学生班级主人翁的意识,爱护班级里的物品。
◆文化意识
了解英语在班级、年级编号等表达方式上与汉语的不同之处。
教具准备
1.单词卡片:grade,class,classroom,see,again,our等。2.不同班级的班牌。
3.mickey和kitty等学生喜爱的卡通人物头饰若干。4.录音机或教学光盘。
教学过程
1.师生互致问候。
出新词see和again的学习。3.欣赏歌曲:in the classroom.4.通过歌曲,揭示并板书课题:unit 1 our classroom part a 教师指着教室说:“this is our classroom.”引出新词classroom,our和词组our classroom的教学。step 2 revision 1.教师出示数字1至12的单词卡片,学生大声并快速朗读。先按顺序朗读,再打乱顺序朗读。最快并且读得正确的学生得分。
2.教师将1至12的单词卡片的顺序打乱。给每个小组30秒钟的时间,学生按照座位顺序站起来说出教师手上的数字单词。在30秒钟时间内,说的人数最多的小组获胜。3.游戏——谁的反应最敏捷。
游戏规则:请学生按照座位顺序报数。每逢2和2的倍数的时候,用拍手来代替报数。也可以用3的倍数或5的倍数来操练。step 3 presentation
(一)单词和句型教学
1.教学单词grade和class。
(3)教师出示class和classroom这两个单词,进行对比教学。告诉学生classroom是复合词,是由class和room这两个单词合并构成的。
(4)用快速反应的方法操练class和classroom两个单词。2.初步感知课文。
(2)播放课文教学光盘,让学生边看边思考问题的答案。
(3)引导学生在课文中发现问题的答案:class one,grade four.3.教学词组:class...,grade....(1)教师板书句型i’m in class...,grade....并带读。提醒学生注意班级名称的书写方法,因其是专有名词,所以四个单词的首字母都要大写,中间还有一个逗号。
(2)教师引导学生用i’m in class...,grade....说出自己所在的班级,然后让学生进行课本第3页的let’s act.部分的活动。4.文化渗透。
教师请学生对比班级名称的中英文表达法,引导学生发现其中的不同之处:在汉语中,年级在前,班级在后,英语反之;在汉语中,数字在前,单位在后,英语反之。5.游戏——快速反应。
教师出示不同班级的班牌,请学生快速读出来,并把班牌分别奖励给反应最快的学生,然后请这些学生来到讲台前,手拿班牌站成一排。教师站在他们背后指着某个班牌,全班同学说出这个班牌的英文名称,拿着这块班牌的学生则要迅速举起手中的班牌。
(二)课文教学
1.请全班学生翻开课本第2页,教师播放教学光盘或录音,让学生在语境中理解课文。2.教师再次播放课文,请全班学生跟读。
3.教师再播放课文录音二到三遍,采用全班学生跟读、个别学生或小组跟读的形式学习对话内容。
4.学生分角色表演对话。5.巩固练习。
听力材料:
girl:i’m in class three,grade six.girl:i’m in class one,grade three.boy:i’m in class one,grade four.参考答案:
②class three,grade six.③class one,grade three.④class one,grade four.(三)语音教学
1.教师领读单词arm,card,park和star。引导学生发现这些单词中包含同样的发音。2.教师引导学生发现单词arm,card,park和star中包含着同一个字母组合ar,并且这个字母组合在这四个单词中都发相同的音[a:]。
3.教师出示今天所学的两个单词class和classroom,先引导学生发现字母a在这两个单词中相同的发音,然后引导学生回忆学过的单词,如:father。
4.教师引导学生得出结论:在单词中,字母组合ar或者是字母a都可能发[ɑ:]的音。5.教师播放课本第3页的listen and learn the english sounds的录音,学生模仿跟读,学习字母组合ar在单词中的读音。step 4 extension 1.教师出示学生喜爱的卡通人物的头饰和两个班牌。2.教师与一个学生模拟会话:
t:hello,mickey.nice to see you again.s1:hello,kitty.nice to see you,too.3.同桌两人一组进行对话练习。
4.请几位学生上台,戴上头饰进行表演。1.听课文录音,模仿并熟读课文。2.完成《活动手册》中本课的练习。
教学目标
◆语言知识目标
1.学习单词chair,desk,blackboard和tiger,初步运用单词look,read,after及词组look at,懂得isn’t是is not的缩写。2.学习句型:i like my....look at the....it isn’t a....3.学习字母组合er在单词中的发音。4.学说韵律诗:my classroom.5.功能:用英语描述自己的教室及教室里的事物。
◆语言技能目标
1.能认读并正确书写单词chair,desk,blackboard,tiger,look,read和after。2.能认读词组look at,知道is not的缩写是isn’t。3.能使用句子i like....来表达自己的喜好。
◆情感态度
培养学生爱护公物的良好习惯。
篇五:新闽教版 小学英语四年级上册全册教案 第一学期全套教学设计
闽教版小学英语四年级上册教案 unit 1our classroom 教学目标
◆语言知识目标
1.学习单词grade,class,classroom,并能够初步运用see,again,our等单词。2.学习句型:i’m in class...,grade....3.学习字母组合ar在单词中的发音。4.学唱歌曲:in the classroom.5.功能:能用英语表达自己所在的班级名称。◆语言技能目标
1.能认读和正确书写单词grade,class和classroom。
2.能准确使用句型i’m in class...,grade....来描述自己所在的班级。
◆情感态度
培养学生班级主人翁的意识,爱护班级里的物品。
◆文化意识
了解英语在班级、年级编号等表达方式上与汉语的不同之处。
教具准备
1.单词卡片:grade,class,classroom,see,again,our等。2.不同班级的班牌。
3.mickey和kitty等学生喜爱的卡通人物头饰若干。4.录音机或教学光盘。
教学过程
1.师生互致问候。
3.欣赏歌曲:in the classroom.4.通过歌曲,揭示并板书课题:unit 1 our classroom part a 教师指着教室说:“this is our classroom.”引出新词classroom,our和词组our classroom的教学。step 2 revision 1.教师出示数字1至12的单词卡片,学生大声并快速朗读。先按顺序朗读,再打乱顺
序朗读。最快并且读得正确的学生得分。
2.教师将1至12的单词卡片的顺序打乱。给每个小组30秒钟的时间,学生按照座位顺序站起来说出教师手上的数字单词。在30秒钟时间内,说的人数最多的小组获胜。3.游戏——谁的反应最敏捷。
游戏规则:请学生按照座位顺序报数。每逢2和2的倍数的时候,用拍手来代替报数。也可以用3的倍数或5的倍数来操练。step 3 presentation
(一)单词和句型教学
1.教学单词grade和class。
(3)教师出示class和classroom这两个单词,进行对比教学。告诉学生classroom是复合词,是由class和room这两个单词合并构成的。
(4)用快速反应的方法操练class和classroom两个单词。2.初步感知课文。
(2)播放课文教学光盘,让学生边看边思考问题的答案。
(3)引导学生在课文中发现问题的答案:class one,grade four.3.教学词组:class...,grade....(1)教师板书句型i’m in class...,grade....并带读。提醒学生注意班级名称的书写方法,因其是专有名词,所以四个单词的首字母都要大写,中间还有一个逗号。
(2)教师引导学生用i’m in class...,grade....说出自己所在的班级,然后让学生进行课本第3页的let’s act.部分的活动。4.文化渗透。
教师请学生对比班级名称的中英文表达法,引导学生发现其中的不同之处:在汉语中,年级在前,班级在后,英语反之;在汉语中,数字在前,单位在后,英语反之。5.游戏——快速反应。教师出示不同班级的班牌,请学生快速读出来,并把班牌分别奖励给反应最快的学生,然后请这些学生来到讲台前,手拿班牌站成一排。教师站在他们背后指着某个班牌,全班同学说出这个班牌的英文名称,拿着这块班牌的学生则要迅速举起手中的班牌。
(二)课文教学
1.请全班学生翻开课本第2页,教师播放教学光盘或录音,让学生在语境中理解课文。2.教师再次播放课文,请全班学生跟读。
3.教师再播放课文录音二到三遍,采用全班学生跟读、个别学生或小组跟读的形式学习对话内容。
4.学生分角色表演对话。5.巩固练习。
听力材料:
girl:i’m in class three,grade six.girl:i’m in class one,grade three.boy:i’m in class one,grade four.参考答案:
②class three,grade six.③class one,grade three.④class one,grade four.(三)语音教学
1.教师领读单词arm,card,park和star。引导学生发现这些单词中包含同样的发音。2.教师引导学生发现单词arm,card,park和star中包含着同一个字母组合ar,并且这个字母组合在这四个单词中都发相同的音[a:]。
3.教师出示今天所学的两个单词class和classroom,先引导学生发现字母a在这两个单词中相同的发音,然后引导学生回忆学过的单词,如:father。
4.教师引导学生得出结论:在单词中,字母组合ar或者是字母a都可能发[ɑ:]的音。5.教师播放课本第3页的listen and learn the english sounds的录音,学生模仿跟读,学习字母组合ar在单词中的读音。step 4 extension 1.教师出示学生喜爱的卡通人物的头饰和两个班牌。2.教师与一个学生模拟会话:
t:hello,mickey.nice to see you again.s1:hello,kitty.nice to see you,too.3.同桌两人一组进行对话练习。
4.请几位学生上台,戴上头饰进行表演。1.听课文录音,模仿并熟读课文。2.完成《活动手册》中本课的练习。3.用英语向父母说出自己所在的班级。
教学目标
◆语言知识目标
1.学习单词chair,desk,blackboard和tiger,初步运用单词look,read,after及词组look at,懂得isn’t是is not的缩写。2.学习句型:i like my....look at the....it isn’t a....3.学习字母组合er在单词中的发音。4.学说韵律诗:my classroom.5.功能:用英语描述自己的教室及教室里的事物。
◆语言技能目标
1.能认读并正确书写单词chair,desk,blackboard,tiger,look,read和after。2.能认读词组look at,知道is not的缩写是isn’t。3.能使用句子i like....来表达自己的喜好。
◆情感态度
培养学生爱护公物的良好习惯。
教具准备
1.单词卡片:chair,desk,blackboard,tiger等。2.一本台历或几块班牌。
3.sally,julia和yang ming的头饰。4.录音机或教学光盘。
教学过程
1.师生互致问候。2.师生自由对话,如: good morning.nice to see you again.3.听录音,齐唱歌曲:in the classroom.4.揭示并板书课题:unit 1 our classroompart b step 2 revision 1.通过课题,引出classroom。教师出示图片和单词卡片,复习单词classroom。2.复习句子:i’m in class...,grade....(2)出示自制的班牌,请学生快速说出班级名称。
(3)游戏——30秒快速反应。
游戏规则:教师出示台历或班牌,class和grade是固定的,但数字可以像台历一样翻动变化。给每个小组30秒钟的时间,小组成员按顺序根据班牌说句子:i’m in class...,grade....30秒内看哪个小组说对的人数多,哪个小组就获胜。
3.教师播放课文教学光盘,请全班学生一起学说韵律诗:my classroom.my classroom 我的教室
in my classroom,在我的教室里,i can see a blackboard 我能看见黑板 for you and for me.你和我都能用。in my classroom,在我的教室里,i can see desks and chairs我能看见桌椅 for you and for me.你和我都能用。step 3 presentation
(一)单词和句型教学
1.教学单词chair,desk和blackboard。
(3)游戏——bomb game。
2.教学单词look,词组look at和句子look at the....look at me.look at the blackboard.look at the clock.look at your books.“look at...”这个句型教学有一定困难。学生爱用“look”,但常常忘带“at”,所以教师要多给一些例句。
(2)教师带领学生边做动作边说这几个句子。
(3)游戏——我说你做。
游戏规则:每组请一位学生上台,面向全体学生站好。教师手指黑板上的图片chair,全班学生发指令:look at the chair.台上四位学生要做手搭在额头上眺望的动作,并看向椅子,做错或做慢的同学出局。以此类推,最后获胜的学生所在的小组获得加分。
四年级上册英语课件(篇12)
内容分析:
本课是新标准英语(三年级起始)第三册第十模块,它的语言功能主要是运用There be句型去描述与月份相关的事情。第一单元以故事情境——Lingling与MsSmart谈论玲玲朋友生日个数的对话呈现,主要是在巩固There be句型的同时学习1——6月份的表达方式。第二单元则是继续描述7——12月份生日个数的情况,并谈论全年不同月份当地的天气状况以及喜欢的运动。本模块预计四课时完成,本课时为第一课时。
情况分析:
(1)四年级的学生接触英语已有一年之久,对英语学习的积极性与参与性较高,好动好胜,喜爱小组比赛。同时他们在认读和自学方面比起三年级均有一定程度的提高,能够听音指读、听音选择、听音填空等,能够认读基本单词,并能借助图文了解课文大意。
(2)在本学期第一模块学生已经学习了数词1—100,对于How many? There be 句型在听力方面也有感知与理解。同时,课文中的单词march, birthday, happy等词语学生比较熟悉,结合对话语境能够较快理解课文的背景。
教学目标:
(1)知识能力目标
①能够寻找单词中发音相同的字母组合,以旧带新,听懂、辨别并认读1—6月份的月名,January\ February\March\April\May\June。
②能够在倾听完整语篇情境中看图了解对话内容,并了解、运用There be 句型描述数量。如,January. There are three.
(2)情感态度目标
①培养学生对所学英语中接触的外国文化知识的兴趣。
②让学生通过课文的学习感受生日聚会的快乐,并能在自己快乐的同时表达对父母的爱。
教学重点:
(1)单词:January\February\March\April\May\June
(2)句型:“There be”功能句的简单运用
教学难点:
(1)单词:January和 February单词比较长,记忆比较难;而April\June则是发音难点。
(2)There is和 There are 学生对单数复数概念模糊,容易搞错。
教学过程:
一、Warmer
1、Play a Game: Count count count数数看
T claps hands and asks Ss “How many are there?”
Ss listen ,count and try to say the number or the sentence “There is/ are…”
【设计意图:用老师拍手,学生数数的活动作为热身,既能复习数字,又能在听力方面不断倾听句型There be,为学生在听后运用句型There is / There are做铺垫。】
2、Lead in the evaluation
(1)Put up the cards of the months(出示1—6个月的月份卡,排成桥型),let Ss count the cards and learn to say “There is/ are…”;(板书主要句型于黑板四线格上,并用不同色粉笔突出is和are)
Ss count and learn to say and make out “There is ”and “There are”
(2)Talk about the evaluation——分组PK
【设计意图:巧妙呈现本节课的课堂评价方式:把月份卡(六个月份名的缩写制作成椭圆形卡片)排成桥形贴在黑板上,把全班分成两个小组,要求各小组通过课堂上的表现力争尽快从此岸到达彼岸。同时,通过月份卡的呈现,引导学生数数,并学习运用句型There be准确描述。】
二、Lead in
1、Lead in
T:We’re counting just now. Lingling is counting, too. She is counting her friends’ birthdays.
Present the picture of Lingling’s counting by CAI
【设计意图:由我们自己的数数活动过渡到玲玲的数生日的事情,直接导入课文,简单明了,切中本节课的对话背景。】
2、Listen, read and find the answer
Ask Ss a question about Lingling’s counting ——“How many birthdays are there in a year?”,and let Ss open their books, then plays the tape
Ss read the book, listen to the whole lesson and try to find the answer
【设计意图:通过整体语篇的听力输入,要求学生们速听速读课文,整体感知对话情境,进而思考回答问题。培养学生认真倾听,认读思考的良好自学习惯。】
3、Present the Topic
Show Picture Two to Ss and present the task of this module
Read the title together: ——Module 10 The Months
Unit 1 There is one birthday in May.
S三、Presentation and Practice
1、Listen and fill in the blanks
Ask Ss the questions about Picture Two——“How many birthdays are there in January/ February/ March/ April/ May/ June?”
Ss listen to each sentence and fill in the blanks
《随堂练兵卡》一、听音填空
一月January. There are .
二月February. There are .
三月March. There is .
四月April. There are .
五月May. There is .
六月June. There are .
【设计意图:抓住课文的重点段落,让学生有针对性地倾听,再通过随堂练兵一听音填空这个听力练习任务,引导学生再次边听边精读课文第二段,完成听力任务,使阅读更具目标性和实效性。】
2、Learn the months
Present the months of this exercise paper(《随堂练兵卡》)by CAI and ask Ss “ 哪个月份生日个数最少?”
Ss read the paper(《随堂练兵卡》) and find out ——March / May, then learn together
(1)Present the word, the phonetic symbol and the calendar from CAI, then Listen its pronunciation
(2)Read the word by syllables and then read after T
读单词的方法:小组开火车读,大小声读,男女生读
Game: 四面开花(请一个学生起来读单词,接着此学生前后左右的学生紧跟着读。看一看哪个学生反应慢,必须再次接受处罚:独自读单词三遍。)
(3)The same way to learn the names of the other months通过提问“哪个月份生日个数最多?”“哪两个月份名称类似”等等逐一呈现剩下的月份名并学习
(4)Practice the words ——快速反应
老师说节日名称,学生对出月份英语名称;老师说月份如“五月,五月”,学生说出其对应英语名称“May”;反之亦然。
【设计意图:由针对玲玲朋友生日个数的情况提问继而学习月份名,由浅入深,逐一突破重难点。在学习新单词的过程中引导学生运用以旧带新(march—— March)、比较法(February_——January)、元音音节法来突破发音难点,模仿发音,同时结合各个月份的节日、月份的儿歌来练习记忆单词。最后让学生谈论自己喜欢的月份,进行巩固拓展。
这种新旧知识滚雪球式的融合形式能充分调动学生积极的情感,变机械和单纯的游戏为情感的表达,回归语言学科教学的本质,让复习操练更具人文性和学科性特点。】
3、Practice
Play a Game:Guess Which month看由来猜月份
Present the origins of the months by CAI
Ss read the origins and guess the month
CAI呈现如下。
(1)在罗马传说中,有一位名叫雅努斯的守护神,生有先后两张脸,一张回顾过去,一张要眺望未来。人们认为选择他的名字作为除旧迎新的月名,很有意义。——January
(2)这个月份正是大地回春,鲜花初绽的美好季节。由拉丁文“开花的日子”演变而来。——April
【设计意图:借助外国文化知识的渗透点燃学生对月份学习的兴趣。让学生在饶有趣味的猜测中复习巩固月份单词,同时月份由来更作为课堂知识的课外延伸,达到课已尽、学无涯的目的。】
4、Read the dialogue of Picture Two
Read Picture Two of the lesson after the CD—Rom
Read by themselves
四、Extensive Reading
1、Present the form,ask and answer
Present the form of the birthdays from January to June in class, ask Ss to describe it
出示一张课前老师调查的关于班级上1—6月份同学生日个数的统计表格,让学生看表格描述
2、Practice in pairs
Ss read the form and describe with partners
【设计意图:语言的学习主要在于运用。在理解课文的基础上联系生活,让学生在真实自然的任务型活动中拓展运用阅读信息,补充阅读材料,让学生有话可说,提高阅读能力和语言表达能力。】
五、Sum-up
Sum up the lesson and expend to the emotion education——Don’t forget to express our love to parents on our birthdays. And then finish the blackboard writing.
六、Homework
两种不同的作业供学生根据自己的需求和能力去选择完成。
四年级上册英语课件(篇13)
一、教材分析
前两课我们学习了my family. 学会了 my dad, my mum,my uncle, my aunt, my cousin,以及他们的names。这一课我们来了解一下我们家还有什么人。当然还有我的爷爷grandpa和奶奶grandma。现在我们有a big family,一大家子人了。
二、教学目的`及重难点分析:
1.会说会用这些句子:
Who are they?
They are kind.
I love them.
2.会说会用会写这些单词grandpa grandma love kind 。
3. 学会用 lovely kind friendly来描述某人怎么样。
4.了解they和them的用法区别,还可拓展到he-him, she-her,I-me的用法。
三、课前准备:
1.教师准备第18页挂图。
2.教师准备自家的全家福照片。
3.学生准备自家的全家福照片 。
4.教师准备grandpa grandma love kind lovely friendly 单词卡片。
四、教学过程
1.Warming up
展示第10页挂图 ,让学生看图,教师同学生进行对话复习上节课知识 :
T: Look at this picture again. The girl is lovely. Who is the girl?
Ss:She is Linda Smith.
T:Who is the man?
Ss:He is Linda’s dad.
T:What’s his name?
Ss:His name is Bob Smith.
T:The lady is friendly.Who is she?
Ss:She is Linda’s mum. Her name is Ann Smith.
T:Is this lady Linda’s aunt?
Ss:Yes, she is.Her name is Nancy Smith.
T:This is her uncle,am I right?
Ss:Yes. His name is Sam Smith.
T:The boy is lovely.Who is he?
Ss:His name is Billy Smith.He is Linda’s cousin.
2. New Presentation
学习句型和词汇:
1)老师指着自己全家福上的家人,同学生采取谈话的方式介绍生词
Who is he ? Who are they?
He is my dad .
Who is she?
She is my mum.
Who are they?
They are my mum and dad. They are my parents. I love them.
四年级上册英语课件(篇14)
(人教PEP)四年级英语上册教案
Unit 1 My classroom
1.本单元要求会听,说,认读的单词:
windowboardlightpicturedoorfloor classroomcomputerwallteacher’s deskfanwhatinthewehavenewgowhere
2.本单元要求会听,说的单词和词组:
manyourseatnearclassmateclean
have a lookgood ideaall rightgood job
3.帮助学生在掌握单词的基础上造出句子,编出对话,学以致用。
4.培养学生用英语交流的能力,为学生的进一步学习奠定基础。
一、教学内容
二、教学要求
能听懂、会说,会用每一课会话。
掌握本单元出现的生词,词组和字母。
会唱本单元的歌曲。
三、教学重点和难点
对于较长的单词如classroom, classmate, computer的掌握以及对于第一次出现的词组和短语如have a look, good job的掌握。
对于礼貌用语“Thank you , Excuse me, After you”的掌握与应用。
描述教室中所有物件,并能据此编出对话。
四、教学时间
本单元共6课时,每周3课时,2周完成。
Lesson3
1.Teaching aims
Let the students master the letters A, B, C, D, E.Remember the words and expressions:
computer, wall, fan and the teacher's desk
2.Teaching aids
a tape-recorderpicturescards
3.Teaching steps
(1)Greetings
Says “Good morning!” to everybody and talk something about the weather and the date.(2)Revision
Let the students listen to the tape and follow it sentence by sentence.Then all the students read the text together.Next, ask some ones to read the text.At last, ask some questions and let them answer.(3)New content
The teacher asks the students to look at the board while he writes “Aa Bb Cc Dd Ee ”.Then ask the students to practice them on their exercise-books.Then ask some ones to come to the board and write the letters to them.Next, let others see whether there is mistake.“Fill in the blank”.A: The teacher gives the students several letters of a word.B: Let the students guess what the word is.Then ask them to fill in the blanks.Do exercises about the 6 words.3)Listen to the tape and ask the students to do the students’ book.Then the teacher checks the answers.Bingo
Let the students look at the “Bingo” in the book and the teacher explains it to them.Then listen to the teacher and cross it.Choose the students who do it very quickly and finally be winner.4.Homework
Let the students to memorize the words.Recite the whole dialogue.5.Teaching notes
四年级上册英语课件(篇15)
《what's the matter》
教学目标:
1.能够听说读写表情情绪的五个单词:tired, angry, excited, happy, sad ,以及四会句子:How are you? You look so happy. You look sad taday.”
2.能够听说认读读句子:How are you?Liu Yun? You look so happy.I’m sorry to hear that并能在实际情境中运用。
3.学唱歌曲:The way I feel
教学重难:
使学生熟练掌握四会单词和句子,并能在实际情境中运用。
教学难点:
学生陈述产生某种心情的原因。
教具准备:
1.教师准备本课时所需的词卡。
2.教师准备录音机和录音带。
教学过程:
一、Preparation
1、Free talk
How do you feel if you have the llu?
What do you do if you have the llu?
2、拼句子活动
出示小黑板
(1)is with the what matter you?
(2)you feel How do /
(3)throat,my sore is
把学生分成两个大组,让他们快看,快拼句子,最后哪组拼提既对又快就可以获胜,教师给予奖励。
【设计意图】通过自由会话和连词成句来复习巩固前面所学的内容,为新课做好铺垫
二、Presentation
(一)Let’s learn
1、上面的活动结束后,获胜的小组肯定会很兴奋,这时老师指着他们对另一组学生说:Look! They are so excited” 老师反复说几遍,让学生看老师的口形,听清后跟读,教师板书单词:excited 教师问:How do you feel ?生答:I’m excited. 之后老师指其中一生问:How does she/he feel ?示意让生答:She/he is excited 这样示范一两遍后,让学生互相问答。(先找一生站起来,并做出兴奋的样子)。
2、教师做出“开心”的样子对学生说:You are very happy. I am happy, too.Look at my face.This is a happy face. 然后在黑板上画happy face.和sad face. ,这时教师指着sad face 问学生:Is it a happy face?以此来教学单词happy 和 sad。并板书这两个单词。然后找两同学上台,其中一生做笑脸的表情,另一学生做难过的表情,老师问:How does she/he feel?让生答:She’s/he’s__________
3、老师出示一张画有“无聊”的人物图片,问学生:Is he happy ?学生肯定答:No. 老师接着问:How does she feel?学生有可能会答:He is sad .老师这时补充说:He is bored. 并板书此单词,老师再用肢体动作和表情来帮学生理解其含义。
4、教师课前安排好两名学生这时在下面搞小动作,被老师发现了,老师立刻停止讲课,并做出生气的表情,当这两生听见没有声音时,问老师:How are you ,Miss Liang?师接着说:I’m angry. 并板书教生认读(师这时表情变为笑脸)然后同桌之间互相做表情,进行问答。
5、“边听边做”活动
教师发指令,师生一起做,如:Stand up! Run! Walk! Jump! Jump! Jump10 times.活动结束后,教师说:I’m very tired. 并板书:tired. 让学生拼读。
6、教师放Let’s learn 录音,学生跟读单词。
7、Practice
(1)请你猜活动
教师先示范,教师做出的各种表情,让学生猜:Are you happy. /tired/bored....?然后再找一生上台做表情,让其他学生猜,并用以上的问答最后学生两人一组,一个做表情,另一个猜,并会使用:Are you....?和Do you feel ...? 两个句子提问。
【设计意图】通过设计此活动,来复习巩固所学的单词,同时活跃了课堂气氛,放松了学生的心情,为下面继续学习提高了学生的参与积极性。
(二)Let’s try
1、 You look so happy. But how do these children feel?放Let’s try 录音,让学生看图,静听一遍,然后再放一遍,让学生看图,听音,标号。
2、Tom is tired. Mary is sad. Jack is bored. But what’s the matter with them? 学生看书上 Let’s start 图说:Look at the picture. What are they doing? What’s the matter with them? They look so tired. I’m sure they have had a big trip. 教学新词 trip 并板书a big trip 领读。
(三)Let’s talk
3、They look so tired. They had a big trip. But
(1)How i s Liu Yun? Is she happy? Is she excited? Why? (让学生听音回答问题)
(2)教师再问:Is Sarah happy? How does she feel? Why? 让学生接着听音回答。
(3)请学生打开书再听录音,当听到I failed the math test. 这句时,停止听音,板书此句话,拿出准备好的一张成绩很差的数学试卷,让学生了解此句意思,然后再听两遍录音。
(4)、听音、跟读、正音。
【设计意图】通过多次听音,训练了学生的听力,从而为学生学习阅读课作了铺垫。
三、Practice
1、师生表演对话。
2、分两组进行对话练习。
3、找两生上台表演对话,根据本部分进行关键词的替换练习。(至少找三对)
4、书写四会句子、单词。
四、Production
Pair work
1、师先示范,师做出开心的表情问学生:Look at me. How do I feel? 学生说:You look so happy. 师马上肯定地说:Yes. Because you have done a good job. 教师再做出不开心的表情问学生:How do I feel now? 学生说:You look sad. 师说:Yes, because I have a headache提示学生说:I am sorry to hear that. 然后再找一名学生做表情,让师猜,并用以上此主句型,最后小组之间各找一生做不同表情,其他几个问,以此来练习本课所学的主要内容。这时教师在班里走动指导,帮助学生陈述产生这种心情的原因。
2、各小组找代表来进行相互问答练习。
【设计意图】通过师先示范,再指导学生表达自己的各种情绪和产生这种心情的原因,这校既培养了学生合作学习的意识,又增强了学生的集体荣誉感和耐挫折能力。
五、Progress、
1.做基础训练P16第1、2、5题。
2.homework:抄写四会单词和句子。
3.Sumarry.
板书设计:
Unit 2 What’s the matter, Mike?
tired angry
How are you?
excited happy
I’m……
sad bored.
You look so happy.
I’m sorry to hear that